kx0803 PDF
kx0803 PDF
kx0803 PDF
KUBOTA EXCAVATOR
KX080-3
Code No.97899-61620
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Record of Revisions
Symbol Date Main Revised Points & Corrective Measures Person-in-charge
II Machine body
• Mechanism section
• Service section
III Engine
• Mechanism section
• Service section
IV Hydraulic System
• Mechanism section
• Service section
V Electrical System
• Mechanism section
• Service section
I General
I-1
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
KX080-3 WSM General
I-2
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service General
Aug. Q R
Name plate : Code No. RA018-57721
Sept. S T
(3) Engine serial number
Oct. U V
e.g. D1105-5L0025
“5” indicates year of 2005 and “L” indicates June. Nov. W X
So, 5L indicates that the engine was manufac- Dec. Y Z
tured in June 2005.
I-3
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service General
I-4
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service General
(2) Reassembly
1. Clean all parts before assembly. Repair any scratches or dents. Take special precautions against dirt and
dust.
2. Parts with rust-preventive coatings must be assembles only after removing the coating.
3. Separated parts must be correctly reassembled using alignment marks.
4. As a rule, use a press to reassembled bearings, bushing and oil seals. Use pads when using a hammer.
I-5
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
KX080-3 WSM General
a. Essential Adhesives
Type of screw adhesive
• Unless otherwise specified, use Three-Bond 1324 adhesive (medium-duty type).
Keep the screw threads free of oil and water.
Type of instantaneous adhesive
• Use Three-Bond 1733 or Three-Bond 1741E adhesive.
Keep the bond areas free of oil and water.
I-6
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service General
E.SERVICING FUNDAMENTALS
a. Items for Servicing
Locking adhesive
(1) Tighten bolts, nuts, adapters,and similar parts
to their specified torques which are given in the
list of tightening torques and adhesive as well
as in this manual. Be sure to observe the
specified torques for important tightened parts
and components.
(2) Wipe out water, oil and grease off the screws
on which LOCTITE adhesive is to be applied.
Be sure to apply the adhesive to specified
locations.
Types of screw adhesive
Equivalent to LOCTITE 271 (Heavy-duty)
Equivalent to THREE-BOND 1305P (Heavy-duty)
Equivalent to THREE-BOND TB1401B (Light-duty)
Unless specified otherwise, use THREE-BOND 1324
(Medium-duty).
I-7
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service General
(4) Precautions in tightening hoses and pipes.
• Flexible hoses have a slight natural bend of
their own. Utilize the natural bend. Be also
careful not to twist them.
• Be careful not to confuse the routes of the
hoses.
• Do not hold the hoses in tight contact with
their adjacent parts and surfaces.
• Tightening steps
1. First tighten the nut to its specified
torque.
2. Then loosen the nut by about 45° to fit
the seat of the joint to the connection.
I-8
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service General
(2) O-ring
• Clean up the O-ring groove and deburr its
edge as required.
• Before installing the ring, be sure to apply
lubricant (grease) over it. (Do not do this to
the floating seal.)
• Fit the O-ring into its groove without twist.
With your fingertip, push the ring gently and
evenly into the final position. Otherwise the
ring would easily get twisted in contact with
the inner edge of the groove.
I-9
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service General
(4) Oil seal
• Do not confuse the orientation of the oil
seal lips. Direct the main lip toward the oil
chamber; in other word, toward what is to
be sealed.
I-10
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service General
c. Piping
(1) General precautions
• Tightening the pipe socket to the specified torque. If too tight, the socket itself or a hydraulic
component may get damaged. It too loose, an oil leak may result.
• In connecting a new hose or pipe, tighten its nut first to the specified torque and then turn it back
(about 45°). Then tighten it again to the specified torque. (Do not this to the sealing tape-applied
hose or pipe.)
• When disconnecting a vertical hose or pipe, separate its bottom connection first.
• In disconnecting and reconnecting the hose and pipe, be sure to use two wrenches. With one
wrench, restrain the mating part to allow no twist.
• Check the mating connector’s sleeve and the hose’s taper for dust deposits and scratches.
• When the pipe socket has been tightened up, wipe the joint clean. Apply the maximum operating
pressure 2 or 3 times to make sure there is no oil leak.
Nut
Joint body
Sleeve
I-11
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
KX080-3 WSM General
I-12
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service General
I-13
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
KX080-3 WSM General
Bolts, Nuts 4T 7T 9T
Nomial Dia.
SS41 S40C, S45C SCr4
7.8 ~ 9.3 N·m 9.8 ~ 11.3 N·m 12.3 ~ 14.2 N·m
M6 0.80 ~ 0.95 kgf·m 1.00 ~ 1.15 kgf·m 1.25 ~ 1.45 kgf·m
5.8 ~ 6.9 ft·lbf 7.2 ~ 8.3 ft·lbf 9.0 ~ 10.5 ft·lbf
17.7 ~ 20.6 N·m 23.5 ~ 27.5 N·m 29.4 ~ 34.3 N·m
M8 1.80 ~ 2.10 kgf·m 2.40 ~ 2.80 kgf·m 3.00 ~ 3.50 kgf·m
13.0 ~ 15.2 ft·lbf 17.4 ~ 20.3 ft·lbf 21.7 ~ 25.3 ft·lbf
39.2 ~ 45.1 N·m 48.0 ~ 55.9 N·m 60.8 ~ 70.6 N·m
M10 4.00 ~ 4.60 kgf·m 4.90 ~ 5.70 kgf·m 6.20 ~ 7.20 kgf·m
28.9 ~ 33.3 ft·lbf 35.4 ~ 41.2 ft·lbf 44.8 ~ 52.1 ft·lbf
62.8 ~ 72.6 N·m 77.5 ~ 90.2 N·m 103.0 ~ 117.7 N·m
M12 6.40 ~ 7.40 kgf·m 7.90 ~ 9.20 kgf·m 10.50 ~ 12.00 kgf·m
46.3 ~ 53.5 ft·lbf 57.1 ~ 66.5 ft·lbf 75.9~ 86.8 ft·lbf
107.9 ~ 125.5 N·m 123.6 ~ 147.1 N·m 166.7 ~ 196.1 N·m
M14 11.00 ~ 12.80 kgf·m 12.60 ~ 15.0 kgf·m 17.00 ~ 20.00 kgf·m
79.6 ~ 92.6 ft·lbf 91.1 ~ 108.5 ft·lbf 123.0 ~ 144.7 ft·lbf
166.7 ~ 191.2 N·m 196.1 ~ 225.6 N·m 259.9 ~ 304.0 N·m
M16 17.00 ~ 19.50 kgf·m 20.00 ~ 23.00 kgf·m 26.50 ~ 31.00 kgf·m
123.0 ~ 141.0 ft·lbf 144.7 ~ 166.4 ft·lbf 191.7 ~ 224.2 ft·lbf
245.2 ~ 284.4 N·m 274.6 ~ 318.7 N·m 343.2~ 402.1 N·m
M18 25.00 ~ 29.0 kgf·m 28.00 ~ 32.50 kgf·m 35.00 ~ 41.00 kgf·m
180.8 ~ 209.7 ft·lbf 202.5 ~ 235.1 ft·lbf 253.2 ~ 296.5 ft·lbf
333.4~ 392.2 N·m 367.7 ~ 431.5 N·m 519.8 ~ 568.8 N·m
M20 34.00 ~ 40.00 kgf·m 37.50 ~ 44.0 kgf·m 53.00 ~ 58.00 kgf·m
245.9 ~ 389.3 ft·lbf 271.2 ~ 318.2 ft·lbf 383.3 ~ 419.5 ft·lbf
I-14
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service General
(10)Washer-equipped elbow
Tightening torque
Size N·m kgf·m ft·lbs
G1/8 15.0~16.5 1.5~1.7 11.1~12.2
G1/4 24.5~29.4 2.5~3.0 18.1~21.7
G3/8 49.0~53.9 5.0~5.5 36.1~39.8
G1/2 58.8~63.7 6.0~6.5 43.4~47.0
G3/4,G1 117.6~127.4 12.0~13.0 86.7~94.0
G1,1/4 220.5~230.3 22.5~23.5 162.6~169.9
7/8-14UNF 55.9~60.8 5.7~6.2 41.2~44.8
Tightening procedure
1. Connecting with the valve
• Screw in the elbow by hand until the
washer comes into contact.
Note: Clean up the mating seal beforehand.
2. Positioning
• Turn the elbow back to its set position.
Note: Do not make any more than one turn back.
3. Fixing
• Tighten up the lock nut with a wrench.
• Lock nut tightening torque
I-15
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service General
9/16UNF size
Screw size Part code of O ring 35.2~43.1N.m (3.6~4.4kgf.m) 26.0~30.8ft.lbs
9/6UNF RD809-6184Δ
11/16UNF RD809-6161Δ 11/16UNF size
60.0~73.5N.m (6.1~7.5kgf.m) 44.3~54.2ft.lbs
13/16UNF RD809-6162Δ
1-14UNS RD809-6163Δ 13/16UN size
70.6~86.2N.m (7.2~8.8kgf.m) 52.1~63.6ft.lbs
1-14/16UNS size
105.8~129.4N.m (10.8~13.2kgf.m)
78.0~95.4ft.lbs
I-16
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service General
Size (ORS) Union nut (metal sealing type) Union nut (ORS type)
7.8~11.8N.m(0.8~1.2kgf.m)
1/8 (-) -
5.8~8.7ft.lbs
24.5~29.4N.m(2.5~3.0kgf.m) 35.2~43.1N.m(3.6~4.4kgf.m)
1/4 (9/16-18)
18.1~21.7ft.lbs 26.0~31.8ft.lbs
37.2~42.1N.m(3.8~4.3kgf.m) 60.0~73.5N.m(6.1~7.5kgf.m)
3/8 (11/16-16)
27.4~31.1ft.lbs 44.3~54.2ft.lbs
58.8~63.7N.m(6.0~6.5kgf.m) 70.6~86.2N.m(7.2~8.8kgf.m)
1/2 (13/16-16)
43.4~47.0ft.lbs 52.1~63.6ft.lbs
117.6~127.4N.m(12.0~13.0kgf.m) 105.8~129.4N.m(10.8~13.2kgf.m)
3/4 (1-14)
86.7~94.0ft.lbs 78.0~95.4ft.lbs
220.5~230.3N.m(22.5~23.5kgf.m)
1, 1/4 (-) -
162.6~169.9ft.lbs
I-17
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
KX080-3 WSM General
F. Maintenance intervals
a. Maintenance intervals chart : EU-version
I-18
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service General
I-19
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
KX080-3 WSM General
I-20
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service General
The oil level is within the shaded area shown in the figure at left.
In this way, large amount of the hydraulic oil in the cylinders when checking and replenishing is supposed
to return back into the hydraulic tank in order to keep the tank pressurized.
I-21
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
KX080-3 WSM General
d. Recommended oil
IMPORTANT:
1. Before delivery the hydraulic oil used was an ISO 46 viscosity grade.
2. Use engine oil API service classification CD, CE or CF.
3. Use SAE 90 (API, CLA/GL5) as drive unit oil for all seasons.
Mobilube HD80W-90
SAE 75
In winter or Shell Oil S8643
by low MIL-L-2105C
temperatures Mobilube HD80W-90
SAE 80
Shell Spirax HD80W
Gear oil
Mobilube 46 MIL-L-2105
In summer SAE 90
or by high Shell Spirax HD90 Mobilube HD80W-90 MIL-L-2105C
ambient Mobilube HD85W-140 MIL-L-2105C
temperatures SAE 140
Shell Spirax HD140 Mobilube HD80W-140 MIL-L-2105C
In summer
or by high
ISO 68 Shell Tellus T68 Mobil DTE-Oil 16 NUTO H68
ambient
temperatures
Fuel under -5 °C
Light oil No. 1-D (ASTM D975)
(+23 °F)
I-22
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service General
• Check the fuel and hydraulic hoses too at the following periodic inspections.
Inspection intervals Inspection item
Daily inspection Fuel and hydraulic hose connections as well as crimped parts for oil leak
Fuel and hydraulic hose connections as well as crimped parts for oil leak
Monthly inspection
Fuel and hydraulic hoses for damages (cracks, wear-out and peel-off)
Fuel and hydraulic hose connections as well as crimped parts for oil leak
Specified self-imposed (yearly)
Fuel and hydraulic hoses for interference, deformation, degrading, twist and other
inspection
damages (cracks, wear-out, peel-off)
Note: The *-marked hydraulic hoses are Kubota’s genuine ultra wear-resistant hoses. Be sure to use
these parts.
I-23
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism II Machine Body
Mechanism Section
II-M-1
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism II Machine Body
II-M-2
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism I Machine Body
Anti-theft system
ROPS/FOPS cabin
Auto idling
Tight tail
4. Operator’s comfort
Air conditioner
Radio installation kit
Tight tail
Other accessories (Cup holder, etc)
II-M-3
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism I Machine Body
b. Feature points
1. Performance
1-1. Kubota original engine
Kubota original new DI engine contributes for stronger digging force, lower
noise level, and lower fuel consumption.
Working range
Kubota Kubota Takeuchi Difference
KX080-3 KX251 TB175 with TB175
Max. digging reach at mm 7170 6720 7245 -75mm -1%
ground level
Max. digging depth mm 4600 4220 4590 10mm 0%
Max. digging height mm 7300 6665 7290 10mm 0%
Static stability
long arm std arm long arm
condition of measurement
w/o QC w/o QC w/o QC
Over side kgf 734 895 724 10kg 1%
Over front kgf 1062 1100 942 120kg 13%
QC : Quick coupler
Rear overhang
Track width mm 2200 2150 2150 50mm 2%
Rear overhang with 90 mm 320 495 645 -325mm -50%
degree swivel
TTL width mm 2520 2645 2795 -275mm -10%
II-M-4
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism I Machine Body
1100
1420
II-M-5
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism I Machine Body
Engine speed will automatically reduced and Have to push the AI button every time when
Increased, operator doesn, have to push the but- increase/decrease the engine RPM.
ton every time whey they wish...
Less possibility to use ??
6.00 liter/hour
II-M-6
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism I Machine Body
Combined with Kubota Intelligent Control System, operator can adjust the
maximum oil flow of SP1 according to the attachment you use.
Function :
You can adjust the Maximum oil flow of SP1.
100 MAX.
90
80
Maximum flow (L/min)
70
60
50
MID.
40
30
20
10 MIN.
0
Stroke of the knob switch on the lever
II-M-7
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism I Machine Body
Test condition... 100h traveling test ( 10 times load = condition of after 1000h)
Fuel refilling pump will be adopted as standard. In addition, we will adopt the
auto-stop function.(TB175 does not adopt)
II-M-8
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism I Machine Body
For the easier access to the components for daily check and maintenance,
new 8 ton machine is designed with triplebonnet.
3. Safety
3-1. ROPS / FOPS cabin
For the maximum safety for operator, Kubota adopted ROPS/FOPS certified
cabin.
II-M-9
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism I Machine Body
Easy operation
No special procedures needed. Just turn
the key and the engine can be started.
Red programming key
Only programmed keys will enable the With wrong key, several attempting to start
engine to start. engine will activate the alarm.
Easy operation
Combined with digital panel, it enables eas-
ier programming.
II-M-10
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism II Machine Body
(16) (12)
(17) (15)
(18) (14)
(19) (13)
(22)
(20)
(11)
(10)
(9)
(1) Idler
(2) Grease tension cylinder
(3) Upper roller (7)
(4) Track roller
(5) Rubber track
(6) Travel motor
(7) Pilot filter
(8) Air cleaner
(9) Oil gauge
(10) Fuel filter (21)
(11) Engine oil filter
(12) Reserve tank
(13) Fan belt
(14) Alternator
(15) Radiator
(16) Oil tank
(17) Suction filter
(18) Return filter (6)
(19) Battery
(20) Fuel tank
(21) Grease nipples (5)
(22) Washer tank
(4)
(3)
(2)
(1)
II-M-11
II-M-12
319mm(12.6inch)
ޓ1.6inch)
25 40mm(1.0
(3)
334mm(13.1inch) (2) Set the cotter pin into the hole outside.
(3) Rubber track
(4) Iron track
(4)
II-M-13
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism II Machine Body
D.Greasing intervals
Greasing intervals are extended.
Bushing material has been changed from metal (carbon steel) to copper alloy castings (high strength brass).
High-strength brass is excellent in abrasion resistance.
In each rotating area including cylinders, this new material bushing is installed.
In fixed areas, steel bushings are installed. (Materials used for main parts)
CA : Copper alloy casting
SC : Carbon steel
RD809-6645-0 BUSH CA
RD809-6647-0 BUSH SC
RD809-6648-0 BUSH SC
RD809-6642-0 BUSH SC
RD809-6643-0 BUSH SC
CA
RD809-6746-0 BUSH SC
RD809-6747-0 BUSH SC
SC
SC CA
SC
SC
RD809-6659-0 BUSH CA
SC
SC
II-M-14
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism II Machine Body
RD809-6662-0 BUSH CA
RD809-6665-0 BUSH CA
CA
CA
CA CA
CA CA
RD809-6665-0 BUSH CA
RD809-6677-0 BUSH CA
CA
CA
CA
CA
RD809-7442-0 BUSH CA
CA
CA
II-M-15
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism II Machine Body
CAC304C
Continuous castings
Class 4
High strength brass
Copper alloy castings
II-M-16
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Machine body
II Machine Body
Service Section
A.Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . II-S-3
B.Removing and reassembling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . II-S-22
a.Front attachment removing ..................................................................... II-S-22
b.Grease nipple set up ............................................................................... II-S-25
c.Pin and bushing installation ..................................................................... II-S-27
d.Shim installation ....................................................................................... II-S-29
e.Fitting the control lever ............................................................................. II-S-31
f. Travel levers ............................................................................................. II-S-33
g.Dozer lever ............................................................................................... II-S-34
h.Cab ........................................................................................................... II-S-35
i .Bonnet....................................................................................................... II-S-36
j .Sound absorber and insulator .................................................................. II-S-41
k.Counterweight........................................................................................... II-S-48
l. Clearance of cover ................................................................................... II-S-50
m.Labels ....................................................................................................... II-S-51
n.Swivel bearing .......................................................................................... II-S-60
o.Undercarriage ........................................................................................... II-S-61
p.Track adjustment ...................................................................................... II-S-64
q.Swivel frame and track frame................................................................... II-S-65
II-S-1
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Machine body
II-S-2
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Machine body
A.Specifications
a. Machine weight
Truck Arm Unit KX080-3
kgf 7960
STD.
(lbs) (17549)
Rubber
kgf 8020
Long
(lbs) (17681)
Cabin
kgf 8060
STD.
(lbs) (17769)
Steel
kgf 8080
Long
(lbs) (17813)
II-S-3
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Machine body
b. Major specifications
Unit KX080-3
Engine
Vertical, water-cooled
Type 4 cycle, 4 cylinders diesel
Model V3800DI-E2-BH
kW/rpm 49.7/2000
ISO 3046 Net
PS/rpm 67.6/2000
Rated engine output
SAE J1349 Net HP/rpm
SAE J1995 Gross HP/rpm
Displacement cc in3 3769 230.0
Dimensions
Overall length mm in 6410 252.4
Overall width mm in 2200 86.6
Overall crawler width mm in 2200 86.6
Canopy mm in - -
Overall height
Cabin mm in 2540 100.0
Min. ground clearance mm in 386 15.2
Canopy mm in - -
Max. digging depth
Cabin mm in 4602 181.2
Canopy mm in - -
Max. digging height
Cabin mm in 7300 287.4
Canopy mm in - -
Max. digging radius
Cabin mm in 7332 288.7
Canopy mm in - -
Max. dumping height
Cabin mm in 5252 206.8
Swing angle (left/right) deg. 67/60
Low speed km/h mph 3.1 1.9
Travel speed
High speed km/h mph 4.6 2.9
Swivel speed rpm 9.5
kN lbf 55.2 12.4
Low speed
kgf 5633
Max. traction force
kN lbf 34.3 7.7
High speed
kgf 3500
Performance
Tumbler distance mm in 2296 90.4
Tread mm in 2200 86.6
Crawler width x No. of shoe x pitch mm 450 x 80 x 154
(Rubber crawler) in 17.7 x 86 x 6.1
Bucket
Capacity CECE Heaped m3 yd3 0.25 0.327
Width mm in 800 31.5
Blade
Width x height mm in 2200 x 500 86.6 x 19.7
Life above GL / below GL mm in 491 / 502 19.3 / 19.8
II-S-4
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Machine body
II-S-5
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Machine body
d. Dimensions of parts :
(1) Front pins
No. KX080-3D Position
Unit
mm )70 x 200 Swing bracket
1 Pin diameter x length
in. )2.76 x 7.87 -Boom cylinder
mm )80 x 437
2 Pin diameter x length Swing bracket - Boom
in. )3.15 x 17.20
mm )70 x 226
3 Pin diameter x length Boom - Boom cylinder
in. )2.76 x 8.90
mm )70 x 183 Swivel frame
4 Pin diameter x length
in. )2.76 x 7.20 -Swing cylinder
mm )70 x 168 Swing bracket
5 Pin diameter x length
in. )2.76 x 6.61 - Swing cylinder
mm )100 x 474 Swing bracket
6 Pin diameter x length
in. )3.94 x 18.66 - Swivel frame(Lower)
mm )60 x 226
8 Pin diameter x length Boom - Arm cylinder
in. )2.36 x 8.90
mm )60 x 175
9 Pin diameter x length Arm - Arm cylinder
in. )2.36 x 6.89
mm )70 x 332
10 Pin diameter x length Boom - Arm
in. )2.76 x 13.07
mm )60 x 151
11 Pin diameter x length Arm - Bucket cylinder
in. )2.36 x 5.94
mm )60 x 284 Bucket links 1, 2, 3
12 Pin diameter x length
in. )2.36 x 11.18 - Bucket cylinder"
mm )60 x 284
13 Pin diameter x length Arm - Bucket links 2, 3
in. )2.36 x 11.18
mm )60 x 333
14 Pin diameter x length Bucket - Bucket link 1
in. )2.36 x 13.11
mm )60 x 333
15 Pin diameter x length Arm - Bucket
in. )2.36 x 13.11
Note : Service limit of pin and bushing is 1.0mm less and more than original diameter respectively.
O.D.
: length
II-S-6
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Machine body
(2) Bucket
1) Bucket dimensions
No. Unit KX080-3
mm 676
1
in. 26.61
mm 700
2
in. 27.56
mm )130 x t10
3
in. )5.12 x t0.39
mm 290
4
in. 11.42
mm 200
5
in. 7.87
mm 19
6
in. 0.75
mm 45
7
in. 1.77
mm 100
8
in. 3.94
mm )105
9
in. )4.13
mm )120
10
in. )4.72
+0.10
mm )60
+0.05
11
+0.004
in. )2.36
+0.002
+0.10
mm )60
+0.05
12
+0.004
in. )2.36
+0.002
mm 890.5
13
in. 35.06
mm 783
14
in. 30.83
mm 135
15
in. 5.31
mm 165
16
in. 6.50
mm 297
17
in. 11.69
mm 44
18
in. 1.73
II-S-7
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Machine body
II-S-8
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Machine body
E 2)
F A
1) 4)
C
5)
8) D
7)
II-S-9
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Machine body
D
A B
5)
1)
4)
2)
II-S-10
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Machine body
(6) Blade
Unit KX080-3 STD Remark
Blade ass'y code No. RD809-7441-0
mm )60 x 167 Blade am
A : Pin diameter x length
in. )2.36 x 6.57 -Track frame
mm )70 x 147 Blade cylinder
B : Pin diameter x length
in. )2.76 x 5.79 -Track frame
mm )70 x 147 Blade cylinder
C : Pin diameter x length
in. )2.76 x 5.79 -Blade
mm 2200
D : Blade width
in. 86.61
mm 500.0
E : Blade height
in. 19.69
mm 1448
F : Blade length
in. 57.01
G : Blade tip plate mm 90 x 16
height x thickness in. 3.54 x 0.63
mm 600
H : Length between blade arms
in. 23.62
C B
H
F
E
D
II-S-11
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Machine body
II-S-12
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Machine body
II-S-13
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Machine body
e. Quality specification
KX080-3: KE, KUK, KBM Version
Machine specification : Auxiliary port,Wrist rest,STD-arm,japan-cab,KBM-bucket
No Specificatios Items Unit KX080-3 Remarks
Q1 Main Speed JIS A8404
1 1 Machine size mm 6410 ± 128
Total length (Transport)
inch 252.4 ± 5.0
2 mm 2200 ± 22
Total width
inch 86.6 ± 0.9
3 mm - Include grouser height
Total height (Canopy)
inch -
4 mm 2540 ± 25
Total height (Cabin)
inch 100.0 ± 25
2 1 Weight kg - Fuel tank:Full
Machine weight (Canopy)
lbs -
2 kg 7960 ± 159
Machine weight (Cabin)
lbs 17548.6 ± 350.5
3 1 Performance L rpm 9.5 ± 1.0
Swivel speed
2 R rpm 9.5 ± 1.0
3 Rubber km/h 3.1 ± 0.3 Traveling stance:
F1 mph 1.93 ± 0.19 Engine Max.speed
Oil temp. : 50±5°C (122±9°F)
4 Rubber km/h 4.6 ± 0.5
F2 mph 2.86 ± 0.31
Travel speed
5 km/h ±
Steel F1
mph ±
6 km/h ±
Steel F2
mph ±
7 Gradeability deg 30
4 1 Rear end min. turning radius mm 1420 ± 28
inch 55.9 ± 1.1
2 Swivel frame rear ground clearance mm 728 ± 15
inch 28.7 ± 0.6
3 Tumbler center distance mm 2296 ± 69
inch 90.4 ± 2.7
4 Crawler total length mm 2898 ± 87
inch 114.1 ± 3.4
5 Crawler total width mm 2200 ± 44
inch 86.6 ± 1.7
6 Min. ground clearance mm 386 ± 12
inch 15.2 ± 0.5
II-S-14
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Machine body
II-S-15
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Machine body
II-S-16
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Machine body
II-S-17
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Machine body
II-S-18
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Machine body
II-S-19
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Machine body
II-S-20
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Machine body
II-S-21
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Machine body
II-S-22
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Machine body
II-S-23
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Machine body
Shims
Bushings
II-S-24
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Machine body
2.Greasing quantity
Apply grease until it comes out of the other end
of the moving section.
(1)
(5)
(2)
(6) (3)
(7)
(10)
(8) (11)
(9)
(4)
II-S-25
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Machine body
4.Greasing quantity
Apply grease until it comes out of the other end
of the moving section.
(1)Type A
(2)Type B
(3)Type B
(4)Type B
II-S-26
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Machine body
(8) (9)
.)
in
.02
0
5(
0.
C
II-S-27
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Machine body
(1)Pin (anti-rotation)
(2)Bolt
(3)Bushing
(4)Bushing
(5)Pin
(6)Spacer
(7)Bolt
(8)Plain washer
(9)Plate
(10)Bolt
(11)Dust seal (10011508)
(12)Bushing (100115110)
(13)Bushing
(14)Grease fitting (Type C)
(15)Bushing
(16)Pin
(17)Grease fitting (Type B)
(18)Spacer
(19)Bolt
(20)Spring washer
(21)Plain washer
(22)Dust seal(809508)
(23)Bushing(809580)
(24)Collar
(25)Grommet
(26)Pin
(27)Bushing
(28)Bolt (anti-rotation)
(29)Pin
(30)Bolt
(31)Plain washer
(32)Pin
(33)Grease fitting (Type A)
(34)Bolt (anti-rotation)
(35)Bushing
(36)Bushing
(37)Washer
(38)Bolt
(39)Pin
(40)Bolt
(41)Plain washer
(42)Pin
(43)Pin
(44)Bolt
(45)Plain washer
(46)Grease fitting (Type A)
(47)Bolt
(48)Plain washer
(49)Bushing(708280)
(50)Pin
(51)Dust seal (708260)
(52)Grease fitting (Type B)
(53)Bolt
(54)Plain washer
(55)Pin
(56)Grease fitting (Type A)
II-S-28
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Machine body
5 (1)
4 (1)
Fig. A
Boom assembly - Shim (1.0, 110-61) 1)Install the grooved thrust collar (with the
Arm cylinder Shim (0.5, 110-61) groove downward) at the top. Apply grease at
To be selected 8 locations on both sides. (See Fig. A.)
3 (1) (Molybdenum anti-seizure compound may be
used instead.)
Shim (1.0, 110-61)
Arm assembly - Shim (0.5, 110-61)
Arm cylinder To be selected 2)Prepare two different-thickness thrust collars
for the bottom. Try the 3.5 mm thick one first to
2 (1) see if it fits on smoothly. If not, introduce the
3.2 mm thick one.
Boom assembly - (Be sure to select a suitable thrust collar.)
Shim (1.0, 140-71)
Arm assembly Shim (0.5, 140-71)
To be selected
1 (1) (1)Pin
(2)Apply grease
Shim (1.0, 110-61)
Arm assembly - Shim (0.5, 110-61)
Bucket cylinder To be selected
II-S-29
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Machine body
(1)
18
14
16 (2)
17
13
15
(3)
(4)
(16)
(15)
(5)(6)(7)
II-S-30
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Machine body
530 (20.9)
II-S-31
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Machine body
(2)
(1) (3)
C (4)
(7) (5)
(6)
95
II-S-32
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Machine body
2)
f.Travel levers
(3) 1.Adjusting the lever neutral position
Fit the levers in position as shown at left.
3)
2.Adjusting the travel levers
(1)
Keep them at the neutral position.
(2) (1)Dimension from the step end
o 265mm (10.4inch) (reference)
(13)
4.Tightening torque for the pilot valve
RD809-6536', RD809-6534' To be installed
(1)Right lever
(2)Left lever
(3)To-and-fro difference between left and right
levers: Less than 2 mm(0.08inch)
(4)Grip (travel)
(5)Washer-fitted machine screw
(6)Lever (travel, right)
(7)Bolt
(8)Lever (travel, left)
(9)Bolt
(10)Pedal (travel, left)
(11)Bolt
(12)Cover (rubber,travel pedal)
(13)PV valve
1)265r5(10.4r0.20)
2)To-and-fro difference between left and right
levers: Less than 2 mm(0.08inch)
3)15~21(0.59~0.83)
4)Neutral position
unit:mm (inch)
II-S-33
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Machine body
g.Dozer lever
1.Adjusting the dozer lever neutral position
Fit the lever in position as shown at left.
(15)(16)(17)(18)(19)
(20)(21)(22)(23)
in.)
(5.0
127
II-S-34
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Machine body
(2) h.Cab
(1) (2)
1.Anti-vibration rubber (Cab)
(2)
(2)
Tightening torque of mounting bolt
(2)
To be installed
Tightening torque
103.0~117.7N.m (10.5~12.0kgf.m)
(3) 75.9~86.8ft.lbs
Tightening torque
107.9~127.4N.m (11.0~13.0kgf.m)
79.6~94.0ft.lbs
(5)
(6)
(1)Details of A and D (2 locations)
(6) (2)Rear rim lock nut
Spring washer
(8) Washer (fender)
(7) (8) Nut (M16-6T, cab)
(8) Cup (mount rubber)
(3)Step (1)
(8) (4)Frame (swivel)
(8) (5)Anti-vibration rubber (Cab)
Bolt
(6)Washer (anti-vibration runner, ROPS)
Bolt (M16x125L-9T)
(7)Details of B and E (3 locations)
(9) (8)Rear rim lock nut
Spring washer
Washer (fender)
Nut (M16-6T, cab)
(10) Cup (mount rubber)
(9)Step (1)
(10)Frame (swivel)
(11)Anti-vibration rubber (Cab-70)
Bolt
(12)Washer (fender)
Bolt (M16x125L-9T)
(11)
(12)
(12)
II-S-35
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Machine body
i.Bonnet
(7)
(8)
(9) (11)
(10) (12) (13)
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
(14)
(15)
(5)
(6)
(1)Damper (gas)
(2)Headed pin
(3)Plain washer
(4)Snap pin
(5)Grip
(6)Bolt
(7)Hinge (1, hood back)
(8)Bolt
(9)Plain washer
(10)Snap pin
(11/)Hinge (2, hood back)
(12)Bolt
(13)Hood (back)
(14)Lock assembly (hood)
(15)Bolt
II-S-36
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Machine body
(1) (4)
(2) (5)
(6)
(17)
(7) (18)
(8)
(9) (19)
(10)
(11)
(12)
E
(13)
(14) (15)
(16)
(20)
(21)
(22)
(23)
(24)
(3)
II-S-37
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Machine body
(1)
(2)
(5)
(6)
(3)
(4)
II-S-38
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Machine body
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
(16)
(6)
(7)
(8)
(9)
(10)
(11)
(12)
(13)
(17)
(18)
(19)
(14)
(15)
(1)Swivel frame
(2)Frame (center)
(3)Bolt
(4)Grommet (360)
(5)Grommet (450)
(6)Clamp
(7)Bolt
(8)Leaf spring
(9)Bolt
(10)Pump assembly (fuel, filler)
(11)Bolt
(12)Cover (center)
(13)Bolt
(14)Tool box (2)
(15)Bolt
(16)Hinge (1, center cover)
(17)Hinge (2, center cover)
(18)Shaft circlip
(19)Bolt
II-S-39
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Machine body
(3)
(4)
(5)
(6)
(7)
(8)
(9)
(10)
(11)
(12)
(1)
(2)
II-S-40
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Machine body
Trim (hood) 1 2
2
5 3
9 6 1 4
8 11 10 7
II-S-41
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Machine body
7 2 6 3 1 4
26(1.02in.)
II-S-42
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Machine body
6 1
8(0.31in.)
Cover (arch, left)
50(1.97in.) Part name Q'ty Location
Cover (arch, left) 1 1
Grommet (50) 1 5
8 Sound absorber (left cover) 1 6
II-S-43
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Machine body
12(0.47in.) 15(0.59in.)
Cover (1, arch)
Part name Q'ty Location
Cover (1, arch) 1 (1)
(1)
Sound absorber (arch cover 1) 1 (2)
(2)
Trim (1, arch cover 1) 1 (3)
25(0.98n.)
II-S-44
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Machine body
(1)
5(0.20in.)
(7)
(2)
(5)
II-S-45
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Machine body
(4)
(1) (2)
(5)
(6)
II-S-46
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Machine body
(2)
1
(1)
(3)
(4)
(1)Part code
(2)Part name
(3)Q’ty
(4)Location
(5)Cover (tank)
Sound absorber (1, tank cover)
Sound absorber (2, tank cover)
Sound absorber (3, tank cover)
(6)To be applied along these lines
(7)To be applied along these lines
(8)To be applied along this line
(9)To be applied along this line
II-S-47
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Machine body
k. Counterweigt
1.Attaching the weight
Tightening torque
Three M20 bolts at the back (1)Stay (hood lock)
367.7~431.5N.m (37.5~44.0kgf.m) (2)Shim (T2)
271.2~318.3ft.lbs (3)Bolt
(4)Plug (M24)
(5)Weight (870)
Apply screw adhesive (Loctite 271). (6)Bolt
(7)Washer
(8)Spring washer
(9)Cover (weight)
2.Fitting the stay (hook lock), cover (10)Bolt
(11)Plain washer
(weight) and bracket (left cover) (12)Plug
Tightening torque (13)Bracket (left cover)
(14)Bolt
48.1~55.9N.m (4.9~5.7kgf.m) 35.5~41.2ft.lbs
(1)(2)(3)
(4)
(5)
(6)(7)(8)
(13)(14)
(9)(10)(11)
(12)
II-S-48
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Machine body
(5)
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
14
15
85 85
II-S-49
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Machine body
l. Clearances of cover
1.Clearance between cover (left) and weight (870)
Clearance A shown at left
8~12mm(0.31~0.47inch)
(1)Cover (left)
(2)Cover (arch, left)
(3)Cover (front)
(4)Cover (tank)
(5)Cover (right)
(6)Cover (back)
(7)(Same on the other side)
(8)Weight (870)
II-S-50
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Machine body
m. Labels
List of labels
No. Location Part name Q'ty Remarks
1 Control cover (right, top) Label (blade) 1
15 K Label (hydraulic 2) 1
25 K Label (hoisting) 2
31 K Label (inspection) 1
32 K Label (swing) 1
34 K Label (anti-theft) 2
37 K Label (manual) 1
40 K Marking (LPA) 1
II-S-51
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Machine body
II-S-52
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Machine body
(2) (10)
(1)
50(2.0in.)
5(0.20in.)
(7)
0.5(0.02in.)
85(1.4in.)
80(3.1in.)
10(0.39in.)
5(0.20in.)
45(1.8in.)
(3) 110(4.3in.)
(4) (5)
550(21.7in.)
(42)
10(
0.3
9in
.)
(9)
300(11.8in.)
40(1.6in.)
(8) (6)
100(3.9in.)
(1)Label (blade)
(2)Label (control pattern A)
(3)Nameplate (PC board, CE)
(4)Label (bar code)
(5)Label (reflector, white, EU)
(6)Marking (model number, left)
(7)Label (attachment switching)
(8)Marking(model number, right)
(9)Label (lever lock)
(10)To be applied at the center
(42)Label (new-vehicle sticker)
II-S-53
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Machine body
40(1.6in)
20(0.79in)
15(0.59in)
(13)
90(3.5in)
60(2.4in) (10)
(14)
(11)
15(0.59in)
25(1.0in)
(15) 15(0.59in)
15(0.59in)
(12)
(10)Label (greasing)
(11)Label (reflector, white, EU)
(12)Label (fuel filler)
(13)Label (fuel pump)
(14)Label (third line, EU)
(15)Label (hydraulic 2)
II-S-54
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Machine body
(1)
(3)
(4)
(5)
50 385
(2)
11 50
30
30
67
70
95 95
(7)
(6)
II-S-55
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Machine body
15(0.59in.)
60(2.4in.)
5(0.20in.)
10(0.39in.)
II-S-56
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Machine body
(1) (25)
50(2.0in.)
150(5.9in.) (24)
(2)
n.)
(3.1i
80
(4)
(26)
10
0(3
(27)
.9i
(3) 30(
n.)
1.2
in.)
(28)
60(2.4in.)
50(2.0in.)
(24)Marking (Kubota 1)
(2 locations: on both sides)
(25)Label (hoisting)
(2 locations: on both sides)
(26)Label (swing caution)
(2 locations: on both sides)
(27)Label (hoisting)
(2 locations: on both sides)
(28)Label (plug)
(2 locations: on both sides)
II-S-57
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Machine body
(29)
(30)
30(1.2in.)
10(0.39in.)
30(1.2in.)
30(1.2in.)
(31)
5(0.2in.)
90(3.5in.)
(32)
II-S-58
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Machine body
˴ ˴ ˴ ˴ ˴
˴ ˴ ˴ ˴ ˴ ˴
˴
˴
˴ ˴
˴
˴ ˴
˴
˴ ˴ ˴ ˴
˴ ˴˴˴ ˴
˴˴˴
˴
˴˴˴
˴˴˴
˴˴˴˴˴
˴ ˴ ˴˴˴
˴
˴˴˴
˴ ˴
˴ ˴ ˴
˴ ˴
˴ ˴ ˴ ˴ ˴ ˴
˴
˴
˴
˴ ˴
˴ ˴ ˴
˴ ˴
˴ ˴
˴ ˴ ˴ ˴ ˴ ˴ ˴ ˴ ˴
II-S-59
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Machine body
II-S-60
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Machine body
(C)
1.Fitting the bearing (swivel)
(6)
Set the bearing with its specific inner race zone
("S" mark) at the right side of the machine.
(7)
(8)
(9)
(10)
II-S-61
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Machine body
o. Undercarriage
1.Upper roller
1)
1)Upper roller
2)Bolt
Bolt tightening torque
77.5~90.2N.m (7.9~9.2kgf.m)
57.2~66.5ft.lbs
Apply screw adhesive (Loctite 271).
2)
(6)
(3)(4)(5)
(7) (8)
(3)Bolt
(4)Nut
(5)Spring washer
(6)Carrier roller
(7)Machine back
(8)Machine front
II-S-62
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Machine body
2.Track roller
Sprocket and track roller out of alignment
(Idler to be loosely in center)
Within r2 mm (0.08in.) (reference)
(2) (1)
II-S-63
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Machine body
3. Front idler
II-S-64
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Machine body
p. Track adjustment
1.Grease management
No grease leak is allowed.
* Wipe off grease deposits around.
(3)
334mm(13.1inch)
(1)Set the cotter pin into the hole inside.
(2)Set the cotter pin into the hole outside.
(3)Rubber track
(4) (4)Iron track
II-S-65
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Machine body
2.Swivel bearing
3.Track frame
II-S-66
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism III Engine
III. Engine
Mechanism Section
A. Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . III-M-3
a. Engine specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . III-M-3
b. Performance curve. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . III-M-5
c. Different installation from V3800 basic model. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . III-M-7
III-M-1
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism III Engine
III-M-2
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism III Engine
A.Engine
a. Engine specifications
Unit KX080-3 Remarks
Model V3800DI-E2-BH
Number of cylinder 4
mm 100 x 120
Bore x Strok
in 3.94 x 4.72
cc 3769
Displacement
in3 230.01
kW/rpm 47.8 / 2000
Max. output/rpm PS/rpm 65.0 / 2000 New engine s tolerance: 5%
HP/rpm 64.1 / 2000
Compression ratio 20
N.m 262.7 / 1400
Max. torque/rpm kgf.m 26.79 / 1400 New engine s tolerance: 5%
ft.lbf 193.8 / 1400
mm 798 x 548 x 789
Dimensions: L x W x H
in 31.4 x 21.6 x 31.1
kg 278
Dry weight
lbs 612.9
mm 0.23 - 0.27
Valve clearance Cold condition
in 0.0091 - 0.0106
Firing sequence 1-3-4-2
Combustion chamber (Direct Injection)
MPa 3.73 - 3.92 / 2.90
Compression pressure 38 - 40 / 29.6
(A)/(B) kgf/cm2 Ref. value/Service limit
psi 540 - 569 / 421
Fan belt Bando RPF3475
g/kWh 232
Fuel consumption ratio g/PSh 171 Net value
lbs/HPh 0.382
l/h 13.2 Load factor = 100%
Fuel consumption
US gal/h 3.49 Fuel specific gravity = 0.88
Engine speed with idling rmp 1050 50 On the machine
kPa 196 - 392 / 98
Engine oil pressure with rated 2.0 - 4.0 / 1.0
engine rpm kgf/cm2
psi 28 - 57 / 14
MPa 18.6 / 23.5
Fuel injection pressure 190 / 240
1st stage/2nd stage kgf/cm2
psi 2702 / 3414
g/kWh 0.48
Engine oil consumption ratio g/PSh 0.35
lbs/HPh 0.00078
III-M-3
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism III Engine
III-M-4
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism III Engine
b. Performance curve
V3800DI-E2-BH (SAE)
III-M-5
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism III Engine
V3800DI-E2-BH (ISO)
III-M-6
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism III Engine
2. Oil filter
(1) Oil cooler
(2) oil filter
(2) (1)
III-M-7
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism III Engine
III-M-8
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
III Engine
Service Section
A.Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . III-S-3
B.Serviceing specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . III-S-4
C.Disassemble and Reassmble . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . III-S-5
a.Pump coupling ..........................................................................................III-S-5
b.Radiator ....................................................................................................III-S-7
c.Air cleaner ...............................................................................................III-S-10
d.Muffler ......................................................................................................III-S-12
e.Fuel tank ..................................................................................................III-S-14
f. Fuel hose .................................................................................................III-S-17
g.Compressor .............................................................................................III-S-21
h.Control cable ...........................................................................................III-S-22
i. Fan belt ....................................................................................................III-S-23
j .Engine stop lever .....................................................................................III-S-24
k.Engine bracket .........................................................................................III-S-25
l .Engine assy .............................................................................................III-S-27
III-S-1
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
III-S-2
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
A.Troubleshooting
Refer to the following Engine WSM
III-S-3
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
B.Serviceing specifications
Refer to the following Engine WSM
III-S-4
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
4.Pump housing.
5.Pump coupling.
III-S-5
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
6.When reassembling
1) Applying grease to the spline
(1) Apply a proper amount of grease.
(Be careful not to allow it overflow.)
(2)
Be careful to keep the rubber free of grease.
Wipe off grease, if on the rubber, immediately.
Tightening torque
210~230N.m(21.4~23.5kgf.m)154.9~169.6ft.lbs
* Do not apply screw adhesive.
(1)Housing (pump)
(2)Coupling
(3)Apply grease to the spline.
(4)Parallel pin
III-S-6
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
b. Radiator
1. Overall view
(1) Receiver
(2) Condenser
(3) Oil cooler
(4) Radiator
III-S-7
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
(1)
(2) (3)
Over 16(0.63in)
Over 15(0.59in.)
430(16.9in.)
(4)
III-S-8
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
2 Shroud (fan) 1
3 Cover (fan) 1
9 Base (drain) 1
10 Plug 1
11 Rubber-fitted washer 1
12 Hose (drain, 1) 1
13 Hose (drain, 2) 1
(1)
(2)
(3)
III-S-9
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
c. Air cleaner
1.Overall view, engine room.
(1)Air cleaner assy.
3.Inlet hoses
4.Double elements
III-S-10
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
(1)
(9)(10)
(1)Bolt
(2)Hose (2, inlet)
(3)Hose clamp (66-88)
(4)Hose clip (58-75)
(5)Hose (1, inlet)
(6)Hose clip (58-75)
(7)Hose (3, inlet)
(8)Hose clip (58-75)
(9)Hose (3, inlet)
(10)Hose clip (58-75)
III-S-11
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
d. Muffler
1.Overall view.
III-S-12
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
(A)
(A) Front
4.Tightening sequence
* (A): Tighten up first.
Tightening torque
39.2~45.1N.m(4.0~4.6kgf.m)28.9~33.3ft.lbs
* (B): Tighten up second.
* (C): Tighten up second.
Tightening torque
48.1~55.9N.m(4.9~5.7kgf.m)35.5~41.2ft.lbs
* (D): Tighten up third.
* (E): Tighten up fourth.
(1) (2)(3)(4)(5)
(6) (7)
(8)
A
D B
(9) E
(1)Muffler assembly
(2)Cover (muffler)
(3)Bolt
(4)Plain washer
(5)Thermal insulation
(muffler cover)
(6)Flange (muffler)
(7)Face b
(8)Face c
(9)Face d
III-S-13
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
e.Fuel tank
(3)(4) (1)(2)
(5)
(6)
(a)
III-S-14
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
(1)(2)(3)
5.Fitting the washer-fitted elbow (68881-6446')
Position the elbow as shown at left.
Note: Be careful not to confuse the O ring (fuel)
setup.
(Part code of O ring)
RD809-5128'
O ring (P18)
III-S-15
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
(5)(6)(7)
(4)
(8)
(9)
(10)
(11)
III-S-16
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
f. Fuel hose
Fuel tube Fuel tube length Protective tube length
1.Routing condition
A 800mm(31.5in.) 705mm(27.8in.)
Make sure the hoses are out of contact with
B 400mm(15.7in.) 300mm(11.8in.) sharp edges, hot zones and moving parts.
1650mm(65.0in.)
Do not clamp the fuel hose and electrical cable
C 1700mm(66.9in.)
together.
D 200mm(7.9in.) 150mm(5.9in.) See if the hoses are not too tight or locally
E 440mm(17.3in.) 350mm(13.8in.) sagging.
Be careful not to affect the hose diameter.
1450mm(57.1in.)
F 3800mm(149.6in.)
2100mm(82.7in.)
2.Installing the protective tubes
Strictly observe the dimensions specified in the
figure.
(1)Fuel tank
(2)Fuel assembly separator
(3)Fuel pump
(4)Fuel filter assembly
(5)Engine
Hose clamp (6)T joint (fuel filter assembly)
14911-4275'
Pipe clip
14971-4275'
Pipe clip
25(1.0n.)
45(1.8in.) 45(1.8in.) 50(2.0in.) 50(2.0in.) 25(1.0n.) 25(1.0n.)
25(1.0n.)
(6) (5)
III-S-17
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
(6) TO-Y490R-ADIATOR DŠë
AŒ¯
NC Rh’?
G?A
”M
A
EW e,nT‚v?@
‚¢
U heIˆÓ
or‚é
‚È
p?B
tO¯en
N P
A
6-G
F30
0125-601
(7)
‚n
‚h
‚k
(8)
(15)
(12)
(14)
(13)
(9)
(10)
(16)
(11)
(17)
(1)
(2)Filter assembly (fuel)
(3)Fuel return hose
(4)Pass the fuel return hose below the fuel feed hose and
the engine’s injection pipe.
Then connect it to the engine.
(5)(Engine)
(6)Pump assembly (fuel)
(7)Pass the fuel return hose outside of the pump assembly
(fuel) (RD411-5135'), as shown in the figure.
Note: Lay the fuel return hose out of contact with the
pump.
(8)(Partition board)
(9)Pass through this notch of the partition board (RD809-
4153').
(10)Fuel return hose
(11)Fuel feed hose
(12)Filter assembly (separator)
(13)Fuel return hose
(14)Fuel feed hose
(15)Lay the fuel return hose out of contact with the sensor
(fuel) connector.
(16)Pass through the oval hole of the swivel frame.
(17)(Battery mount of the swivel frame)
III-S-18
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
(1)
(5)
A-A A B
(6)
(2) (7)
(3) (8)
(4) (9)
(1)Cord band
(2)Pass both the fuel feed and return hoses through the
guide.
(3)Fuel feed hose
(4)Fuel return hose
(5)Fuel return hose
(6)Fuel feed hose
(7)Pass both the fuel feed and return hoses through the
guide.
(8)Fuel feed hose
(9)Fuel return hose
III-S-19
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
(1)
(2)
(7)
(8)
(4) (9)
(5)
(6)
III-S-20
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
g. Compressor
1.Fitting the bracket (compressor) and
(2)
bracket (pulley)
Fit the brackets in position as shown at left.
Tightening torque
17.7~20.6N.m(1.8~2.1kgf.m)13.1~15.2ft.lbs
(1) M10
48.1~55.9N.m(4.9~5.7kgf.m)35.5~41.2ft.lbs
III-S-21
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
h.Control cable
1.Connecting the cable (acceleration)
Connect the cable in the order as shown in the
figure.
(6)
(1)
(7)
(3) (12)
(2) (8)
(4)
(13)
(9)
(10)
(5)
(11)
(15)
(16)
320
(14)
(17) (18)
(1)Connecting the cable (acceleration) (11) 3) Join the wire fixture and the cable together and
1) Install the wire fixture (36919-1033') on the engine- tighten up the nut.
side acceleration lever. (12)Guide bar
(2)Wire fixture (13)Take the same route along the A/C hose in this arrow-
(3)Engine-side acceleration lever marked zone.
(4)Plain washer (14)Screw in until two threads or so (about 1 mm) stretch
Cotter pin out.
(5) 4) Connections and routing complete (15)A/C hose
(6)To AI motor (16)Pass the cable so that the sponge (EPDM material)
(7)Pass outside of the A/C hose. around the cable comes to these two guides (6 mm
(8) 2) Connect the cableÅfs outer adjuster along the near dia. round bars).
center of the bracket (acceleration cable). (17)A/C hose
(9)32 (reference) (18)EPDM material (sponge)
(10)Cable (acceleration)
III-S-22
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
i. Fan belt
1.Fitting the oil switch
Tightening the oil switch
Fit the oil switch in position as shown at left.
PT1/8 size
7.8~9.3N.m(0.8~0.95kgf.m)5.8~6.9ft.lbs
(2)
(3)
(4)
(1)
(5)
(6)
III-S-23
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
A
(1)
(6)
(7)
(1)
(2)
A
(3) A-A (8)
(4) (8)
(4)
(9)
(5) (10)
(11)
III-S-24
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
k. Engine bracket
1. Overall view.
III-S-25
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
(1)(No. 2 nut)
(2)(No. 1 nut)
(3)Bolt
(4)Collar
(5)Washer
(6)Stud
(7)Washer
(8)Anti-vibration rubber
(9)(Right back)Bracket (1, engine)
(Right front)Bracket (2, engine)
Bolt
III-S-26
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
l. Engine assy
1. Remove and dismount the following parts.
1)Radiator assy
2)Air cleaner assy
3)Bonnet and arch
4)Wireharness
5)Fuel hoses
6)Mount bracket
III-S-27
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
III-S-28
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
D.Engine WSM
TO THE READER
The following engine WSM has been compiled after minor changing of original V3800DI engine WSM by
eliminating some pages which doesn't apply to construction machinery model of KX080-3.
Still some pages contain common specifications on V3800DI series engine.
Therefore, some date may differ from the engine mounted on constructinon machinery.
In that case, please come to the specifications in the front pages of KX080-3 WSM engine chapter.
July 2006
******************************************************************************************************************
This Workshop Manual has been prepared to provide servicing personnel with information on the mechanism,
service and maintenance of V3800DI-E2B, V3800DI-T-E2B. It is divided into three parts, “General”, “Mechanism”
and “Servicing”.
General
Information on the engine identification, the general precautions, maintenance check list, check and maintenance
and special tools are described.
Mechanism
Information on the construction and function are included. This part should be understood before proceeding with
troubleshooting, disassembling and servicing.
Refer to Diesel Engine Mechanism Workshop Manual (Code No. 97897-01870) for the one which has not been
described to this workshop manual.
Servicing
Information on the troubleshooting, servicing specification lists, tightening torque, checking and adjusting,
disassembling and assembling, and servicing which cover procedures, precautions, factory specifications and
allowable limits.
All information illustrations and specifications contained in this manual are based on the latest product information
available at the time of publication.
The right is reserved to make changes in all information at any time without notice.
Due to covering many models of this manual, information or picture being used have not been specified as one
model.
March 2004
© KUBOTA Corporation 2004
III-S-29
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
III-S-30
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
General
III-S-31
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
1. ENGINE IDENTIFICATION
[1] MODEL NAME AND ENGINE SERIAL NUMBER
When contacting the manufacture, always specify your engine
model name and serial number.
The engine model and its serial number need to be identified
before the engine can be serviced or parts replaced.
Engine Serial Number
The engine serial number is an identified number for the engine.
It is marked after the engine model number.
It indicates month and year of manufacture as follows.
• Year of manufacture
Alphabet or Alphabet or
Year Year
Number Number
1 2001 F 2015
2 2002 G 2016
3 2003 H 2017
4 2004 J 2018
5 2005 K 2019
6 2006 L 2020
7 2007 M 2021
8 2008 N 2022
9 2009 P 2023
A 2010 R 2024
B 2011 S 2025
C 2012 T 2026
D 2013 V 2027
E 2014
III-S-32
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
• Month of manufacture
Engine Serial Number
Month
0001 ~ 9999 10000 ~
January A0001 ~ A9999 B0001 ~
February C0001 ~ C9999 D0001 ~
March E0001 ~ E9999 F0001 ~
April G0001 ~ G9999 H0001 ~
May J0001 ~ J9999 K0001 ~
June L0001 ~ L9999 M0001 ~
July N0001 ~ N9999 P0001 ~
August Q0001 ~ Q9999 R0001 ~
September S0001 ~ S9999 T0001 ~
October U0001 ~ U9999 V0001 ~
November W0001 ~ W9999 X0001 ~
December Y0001 ~ Y9999 Z0001 ~
e.g. V3800-3A0001
“3” indicates 2003 and “A” indicates January.
So, 3A indicates that the engine was manufactured in January,
2003.
W1011076
III-S-33
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
2. GENERAL PRECAUTIONS
• During disassembly, carefully arrange removed parts in a clean
area to prevent confusion later. Screws, bolts and nuts should
be replaced in their original position to prevent reassembly
errors.
• When special tools are required, use KUBOTA genuine special
tools. Special tools which are not frequently used should be
made according to the drawings provided.
• Before disassembling or servicing live wires, make sure to
always disconnect the grounding cable from the battery first.
• Remove oil and dirt from parts before measuring.
• Use only KUBOTA genuine parts for parts replacement to
maintain engine performance and to ensure safety.
• Gaskets and O-rings must be replaced during reassembly.
Apply grease to new O-rings or oil seals before assembling.
• When reassembling external or internal snap rings, position
them so that the sharp edge faces against the direction from
which force is applied.
• Be sure to perform run-in the serviced or reassembled engine.
Do not attempt to give heavy load at once, or serious damage
may result to the engine.
(1) Grease (A) External Snap Ring
(2) Force (B) Internal Snap Ring
(3) Place the Sharp Edge against the
Direction of Force
W1011734
III-S-34
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
III-S-35
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
III-S-36
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
III-S-37
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
III-S-38
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
13.2 L
Engine oil capacity
3.49 U.S.gals
(A) Deflection
W1208957
III-S-39
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
III-S-40
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
(A) Deflection
W1014131
Fan Belt Damage and Wear
1. Check the fan belt for damage.
2. If the fan belt is damaged, replace it.
3. Check if the fan belt is worn and sunk in the pulley groove.
4. If the fan belt is nearly worn out and deeply sunk in the pulley
groove, replace it.
(A) Good (B) Bad
W1209480
III-S-41
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
III-S-42
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
13.2 L
Engine oil capacity
3.49 U.S.gals
III-S-43
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
III-S-44
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
Anti-Freeze
• There are two types of anti-freeze available: use the permanent
type (PT) for this engine.
• Before adding anti-freeze for the first time, clean the radiator
interior by pouring fresh, soft water and draining it a few times.
• The procedure for mixing water and anti-freeze differs according
to the make of the anti-freeze and the ambient temperature.
Basically, it should be referred to SAE J1034 standard, more
specifically also to SAE J814c.
• Mix the anti-freeze with fresh, soft water, and then fill into the
radiator.
• When the anti-freeze is mixed with fresh, soft water, the
anti-freeze mixing ratio must be less than 50 %.
Vol % Freezing point Boiling point*
anti-freeze °C °F °C °F
40 –24 –11.2 106 222.8
50 –37 –34.6 108 226.4
* At 1.013 × 100000 Pa (760 mmHg) pressure (atmospheric). A
higher boiling point is obtained by using a radiator pressure cap
which permits the development of pressure within the cooling
system.
• The above data represents industrial standards that
necessitate a minimum glycol content in the concentrated
anti-freeze.
• When the coolant level drops due to evaporation, add fresh,
soft water only to keep the anti-freeze mixing ratio less than
50 %. In case of leakage, add anti-freeze and fresh, soft
water in the specified mixing ratio.
• Anti-freeze absorbs moisture. Keep unused anti-freeze in a
tightly sealed container.
• Do not use radiator cleaning agents when anti-freeze has
been added to the coolant.
(Anti-freeze contains an anti-corrosive agent, which will
react with the radiator cleaning agent forming sludge which
will affect the engine parts.)
W1039218
III-S-45
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
III-S-46
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
III-S-47
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
III-S-48
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
III-S-49
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
III-S-50
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
Injection Timing
1. Make sure of matching the injection timing align mark (1) of the
injection pump unit and the plate (gearcase), as shown in the
illustration.
2. Remove the injection pipes.
3. Remove the stop solenoid.
4. Turn the flywheel counterclockwise (viewed from flywheel side)
until the fuel fills up to the hole of the delivery valve holder (2) for
No.1 cylinder.
5. After the fuel fills up to the hole of the delivery valve holder for
No.1 cylinder, turn back (clockwise) the flywheel around 1.57 rad
(90 °).
6. Turn the flywheel counterclockwise to set at around 0.35 rad
(20 <Symbol>×) before T.D.C..
7. Slowly turn the flywheel counterclockwise and stop turning when
the fuel begins to come up, to get the present injection timing.
8. Check to see the degree on flywheel.
The flywheel has mark “1TC”, “10” and “20” for the crank angle
before the top dead center of No.1 piston.
9. If the injection timing is not within the specification, rotate the
injection pump unit to adjust the injection timing.
• When installing the injection pump unit to the engine body,
follow the correct procedure.
See the “Injection Pump Unit”.
0.21 to 0.24 rad (12 ° to
Injection timing Factory spec.
14 °) before T.D.C.
III-S-51
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
III-S-52
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
13.2 L
Engine oil capacity
3.49 U.S.gals
III-S-53
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
III-S-54
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
III-S-55
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
Replacing Battery
• When the battery is being activated, hydrogen and oxygen
gases in the battery are extremely explosive. Keep open
sparks and flames away from the battery at all times,
especially when charging the battery.
• When charging battery, remove battery vent plugs.
• When disconnecting the cable from the battery, start with
the negative terminal first. When connecting the cable to
the battery, start with the positive terminal first.
• Never check battery charge by placing a metal object
across the posts.
1. Disconnect the negative terminal and positive terminal.
2. Remove the battery holder.
3. Remove the used battery.
4. Replace the new battery.
5. Tighten the battery holder.
6. Connect the positive terminal.
7. Connect the negative terminal.
W1023996
III-S-56
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
5. SPECIAL TOOLS
Diesel Engine Compression Tester
Code No: 07909-30208 (Assembly) 07909-31251 (G)
07909-30934 (A to F) 07909-31271 (I)
07909-31211 (E and F) 07909-31281 (J)
07909-31231 (H)
Application: Use to measure diesel engine compression and
diagnostics of need for major overhaul.
(1) Gauge (7) Adaptor F
(2) L Joint (8) Adaptor G
(3) Adaptor A (9) Adaptor H
(4) Adaptor B (10) Adaptor I
(5) Adaptor C (11) Adaptor J
(6) Adaptor E
W1024200
Oil Pressure Tester
Code No: 07916-32032
Application: Use to measure lubricating oil pressure.
(1) Gauge (5) Adaptor 2
(2) Cable (6) Adaptor 3
(3) Threaded Joint (7) Adaptor 4
(4) Adaptor 1 (8) Adaptor 5
W1024318
III-S-57
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
• The following special tools are not provided, so make them referring to the figure.
Injection Pump Pressure Tester
Application: Use to check fuel tightness of injection pumps.
Pressure gauge full scale : More than 29.4 MPa
A
(300 kgf/cm2, 4267 psi)
B PF 1/2
C Copper gasket
D Flange (Material : Steel)
E Hex. nut 27 mm (1.06 in.) across the plat
F Adhesive application
G Fillet welding on the enter circumference
H Retaining nut
I 17 mm dia. (0.67 in. dia.)
J 8 mm dia. (0.31 in. dia.)
K 1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
L 17 mm dia. (0.67 in. dia.)
M 6.10 to 6.20 mm dia. (0.2402 to 0.2441 in. dia.)
N 8 mm (0.31 in.)
O 4 mm (0.16 in.)
P 11.97 to 11.99 mm dia. (0.4713 to 0.4720 in. dia.)
Q PF 1/2
R 23 mm (0.91 in.)
S 17 mm (0.67 in.)
T 4 mm (0.16 in.)
U 12.00 to 12.02 mm dia. (0.4724 to 0.4732 in. dia.)
V 100 mm (3.94 in.)
W M12 × P1.5
X 5 mm (0.20 in.)
W10252400
III-S-58
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
[Press fit]
A 157 mm (6.181 in.)
B 14.5 mm (0.571 in.)
C 120 mm (4.7244 in.)
D 30.0 mm dia. (1.1811 in. dia.)
E 42.000 mm dia. (1.6535 in. dia.)
F 20 mm dia. (0.7874 in. dia.)
a 6.3 Pm (250 Pin.)
b 6.3 Pm (250 Pin.)
C1 Chamfer 1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
C2 Chamfer 2.0 mm (0.079 in.)
W1040702
Idle Gear Bushing Replacing Tool
Application: Use to press out and to press fit the bushing.
A 196 mm (7.7165 in.)
B 37.5 mm (1.476 in.)
C 150 mm (5.9055 in.)
D 44.95 mm dia. (1.7697 in. dia.)
E 48.075 to 48.100 mm dia. (1.8927 to 1.8937 in. dia.)
F 20 mm dia. (0.7874 in. dia.)
a 6.3 Pm (250 Pin.)
b 6.3 Pm (250 Pin.)
C1 Chamfer 1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
C2 Chamfer 2.0 mm (0.079 in.)
W1040289
III-S-59
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
III-S-60
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
III-S-61
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
III-S-62
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
3) Piece 2
A Chamfer 0.1 mm (0.004 in.)
B 1 mm (0.04 in.)
C Chamfer 1mm (0.04 in.)
D 54.3 to 54.4 mm dia. (2.1378 to 2.1417 in. dia.)
E 34.025 to 34.05 mm dia. (1.3396 to 1.3406 in. dia.)
F 48.5 mm dia. (1.9094 in. dia.)
G 50.421 to 50.44 mm dia. (1.9851 to 1.9858 in. dia.)
H 8 mm (0.31 in.)
I 2 mm (0.08 in.)
J 35 mm dia. (1.38 in. dia.)
K 5 mm (0.20 in.)
L 0.26 rad (15 °)
W1044620
Balancer Bushing Replacing Tool 2
Application: Use to press fit the bushing.
A 35 mm (1.38 in.)
B 33 mm (1.30 in.)
C Chamfer 0.5 mm (0.02 in.)
D 1 mm (0.04 in.)
E Chamfer 1 mm (0.04 in.)
F 40 mm dia. (1.57 in. dia.)
G 50.921 to 50.94 mm dia. (2.0048 to 2.0055 in. dia.)
H 54.8 to 54.9 mm dia. (2.1575 to 2.1614 in. dia.)
I 30 mm dia. (1.18 in. dia.)
J 49 mm dia. (1.93 in. dia.)
K 6 mm (0.24 in.)
L 125 mm (4.92 in.)
M 160 mm (6.30 in.)
N 3 mm (0.12 in.)
O 5 mm (0.20 in.)
P 0.26 rad (15 °)
W1044794
III-S-63
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
III-S-64
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
2) Shaft
A 44 mm dia. (1.73 in. dia.)
B 12 mm (0.47 in.)
C Chamfer 1 mm (0.04 in.)
D 3 mm (0.12 in.)
E 3 mm (0.12 in.)
F 30 mm (1.18 in.)
G 38 mm (1.50 in.)
H 35 mm (1.38 in.)
I M12 u P1.25
J 53 mm (2.09 in.)
K 4 mm (0.16 in.)
L 75 mm (2.95 in.)
M 57 mm (2.24 in.)
N 70 mm (2.76 in.)
O 19.5 mm (0.77 in.)
P 12 mm (0.47 in.)
Q 0.8 mm (0.03 in.)
R 6 mm (0.24 in.)
W1046146
3) Piece 1
A 26 mm (1.02 in.)
B 18 mm (0.71 in.)
C 16.5 to 17.0 mm (0.6496 to 0.6693 in.)
D 1.5 mm (0.06 in.)
E 54.0 to 54.2 mm dia. (2.1260 to 2.1339 in dia.)
F 50.55 to 50.75 mm dia. (1.9902 to 1.9980 in dia.)
G 16 mm (0.63 in.)
H Chamfer 1 mm (0.04 in.)
I 8.5 mm dia. (0.33 in. dia.)
J 0.4 mm (0.0157 in.)
K 3 mm (0.12 in.)
L 19 mm (0.75 in.)
M Chamfer 0.5 mm (0.02 in.)
N 36 mm (1.42 in.)
O 45 mm dia. (1.77 in. dia.)
P 0.78 rad (45 °)
Q 11.5 mm (0.45 in.)
W1047263
III-S-65
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
4) Joint 1
A M12 u P1.25
B Chamfer 1 mm (0.04 in.)
C 30 mm dia. (1.18 in. dia.)
D 13 mm dia. (0.51 in. dia.)
E Chamfer 3 mm (0.12 in.)
F 3 mm (0.12 in.)
G 45 mm (1.77 in.)
H 75 mm (2.95 in.)
I 57 mm (2.24 in.)
J 85 mm (3.35 in.)
K 70 mm (2.76 in.)
L 178 mm (7.01 in.)
W1047709
5) Piece 2
A 26 mm (1.02 in.)
B 18 mm (0.71 in.)
C 16.5 to 17.0 mm (0.6496 to 0.6693 in.)
D 1.5 mm (0.06 in.)
E 53.5 to 53.7 mm dia. (2.1063 to 2.1142 in dia.)
F 50.05 to 50.25 mm dia. (1.9705 to 1.9783 in dia.)
G 16 mm (0.63 in.)
H Chamfer 1 mm (0.04 in.)
I 8.5 mm dia. (0.33 in. dia.)
J 0.4 mm (0.0157 in.)
K 3 mm (0.12 in.)
L 19 mm (0.75 in.)
M Chamfer 0.5 mm (0.02 in.)
N 36 mm (1.42 in.)
O 45 mm dia. (1.77 in. dia.)
P 0.78 rad (45 °)
Q 11.5 mm (0.45 in.)
W1048068
6) Joint 2
A M12 u P1.25
B Chamfer 1 mm (0.04 in.)
C 30 mm dia. (1.18 in. dia.)
D 13 mm dia. (0.51 in. dia.)
E Chamfer 3 mm (0.12 in.)
F 3 mm (0.12 in.)
G 45 mm (1.77 in.)
H 75 mm (2.95 in.)
I 57 mm (2.24 in.)
J 85 mm (3.35 in.)
K 70 mm (2.76 in.)
L 394 mm (15.51 in.)
W1048305
III-S-66
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
7) Piece 3
A 26 mm (1.02 in.)
B 18 mm (0.71 in.)
C 16.5 to 17.0 mm (0.6496 to 0.6693 in.)
D 1.5 mm (0.06 in.)
E 53.0 to 53.2 mm dia. (2.0866 to 2.0945 in dia.)
F 49.55 to 49.75 mm dia. (1.9508 to 1.9587 in dia.)
G 16 mm (0.63 in.)
H Chamfer 1 mm (0.04 in.)
I 8.5 mm dia. (0.33 in. dia.)
J 0.4 mm (0.0157 in.)
K 3 mm (0.12 in.)
L 19 mm (0.75 in.)
M Chamfer 0.5 mm (0.02 in.)
N 36 mm (1.42 in.)
O 45 mm dia. (1.77 in. dia.)
P 0.78 rad (45 °)
Q 11.5 mm (0.45 in.)
W1048484
Injection Pump Gear Puller
Application: Use for remove the injection pump gear from governor
shaft.
A 10 mm dia. (0.39 in.dia.)
B M16 u Pitch 1.5
C 19 mm (0.75 in.)
D 0.5 mm radius (0.02 in. radius)
E 0.87 rad (50 °)
F 10 mm (0.39 in.)
G 20 mm (0.79 in.)
H 5 mm (0.20 in.)
I 95 mm (3.74 in.)
J 125 mm (4.92 in.)
K 5 mm (0.20 in.)
L M16 u Pitch 1.5
M 30 mm (1.18 in.)
N 9.5 mm (0.3740 in.)
O 11 mm (0.4331 in.)
P 9.5 mm (0.3740 in.)
Q 14.5 mm (0.57 in.)
R 5.5 mm radius (0.22 in. radius)
S 20 mm (0.79 in.)
T 20 mm (0.79 in.)
U 80 mm (3.1496 in.)
W 12 mm (0.47 in.)
C2 Chamfer 2.0 mm (0.079 in.)
W1042094
III-S-67
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
Engine Stand
Application: Use to support engine.
A 480 mm (18.90 in.)
B 50 mm (1.97 in.)
C 108.5 mm (4.272 in.)
D 262.5 mm (10.33 in.)
E 12.5 mm (0.492 in.)
F 237.5 mm (9.350 in.)
G 142.5 mm (5.610 in.)
H 95 mm (3.74 in.)
I 14 mm dia. (0.55 in. dia.)
J 40 mm radius (1.57 in. radius)
K 210 mm (8.27 in.)
L 190 mm (7.48 in.)
M 100 mm (3.94 in.)
N 6 mm (0.24 in.)
O 6 mm (0.24 in.)
P 25 mm dia. (0.98 in. dia.)
C10 Chamfer 10 mm (0.394 in.)
W1033645
Flywheel Stopper (for SAE Flywheel and Housing)
Application: Use to loosen and tighten the flywheel screw.
A 140 mm (5.5 in.)
B 80 mm (3.15 in.)
C 49.3 mm (1.94 in.)
D 49.3 mm (1.94 in.)
E 23.8 mm (0.94 in.)
F 23.8 mm (0.94 in.)
G 11 mm dia. (0.43 in. dia.)
H 56.5 mm (2.22 in.)
I 56.5 mm (2.22 in.)
J 8 mm (0.31 in.)
W1042515
Tool for Aligning the Crankcase 1 and 2
Application: Use for aligning the crankcase 1 and 2.
A 115 mm (4.5276 in.)
B 56 mm (2.2047 in.)
C 17 mm (0.6693 in.)
D 20 mm (0.7874 in.)
E 14 mm dia. (0.5512 in. dia.)
F 11 mm dia. (0.4331 in. dia.)
G 14 mm dia. (0.5512 in. dia.)
H 17.5 mm (0.6890 in.)
I 17.5 mm (0.6890 in.)
J 35 mm (1.3780 in.)
K 19 mm (0.7480 in.)
W1047882
III-S-68
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
(1) Material SS400 (3) Pin 05012-00408 (4) O-ring 04811-00150 (5) Arc welding
(2) Material S43C-D
III-S-69
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
III-S-70
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
Mechanism
III-S-71
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
III-S-72
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
1. FEATURE
The V3 series DI engine are the vertical type 4-cycle
diesel engine featuring the advanced performances
shown below.
This is a small sized, high power and environment
conscious engine, which employs the four valve system,
two inlet valves with double ports, and two exhaust
valves with the new E-CDIS. Thus, this engine achieves
high combustion efficiency and complies with various
regulations of exhaust gas.
Based upon the conventional model, Kubota
developed a unique governor system and various new
mechanisms which reduces exhaust emission, noise
and vibration and realize durability and high torque.
W1013043
III-S-73
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
2. ENGINE BODY
[1] CYLINDER BLOCK
This engine employs separate type crankcases - the
crankcase 1 (1) with combustion part and the crankcase
2 (2) which supports the crankcase 1 (1) and reduces
noise.
Since it is a hanger type, you can easily assemble /
disassemble it. The cylinder is a linerless type which
enables good cooling operation, less strain and good
abrasion resistance.
(1) Crankcase 1 (3) Oil Pan
(2) Crankcase 2
W1013119
III-S-74
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
III-S-75
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
[5] PISTON
Piston’s skirt is coated with molybdenum
disulfide<Dingbats>H, which reduces the piston slap
noise and thus the entire operating noise.
III-S-76
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
3. LUBRICATING SYSTEM
[1] OIL COOLER
V3 series engine has a water-cooled oil cooler that
not only cools hot oil, but also warms the cool engine oil
shoftly after start up.
As shown in the figure, the oil flows inside the
connected cooler plate, whereas coolant is kept
circulating outside the cooler plate, thereby cooling
down or warming the oil.
(A) Oil Inlet Port (a) Coolant Inlet Port
(B) Oil Outlet Port (b) Coolant Outlet Port
W10344770
III-S-77
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
4. COOLING SYSTEM
[1] THERMOSTAT
Conventional thermostatically-controlled valves
(outlet water temperature control type) open against the
flow of coolant. In this design, the pressure (steam
pressure + water pump’s discharge pressure) affects the
open/close performance of such valve. In other words,
the valve may be delayed in opening at a preset opening
temperature opening suddenly, above the preset
temperature. This is called the overshoot phenomenon.
The overshoot problem invites the undershoot
phenomenon too. Too much water cooled by the
radiator flows through the water passage, which
suddenly closes the valve below the thermostat’s preset
valve closing temperature.
A repeated cycle of such overshoot and undershoot
phenomena is called the water temperature hunting.
This hunting problem may adversely affects the cooling
system parts, and also the engine and its related
components.
To cope with this trouble, the V3 series engine is
equipped with the flow control thermostat. The valve
has a notch to control the coolant flowrate smoothly in
small steps.
(1) Coolant Temperature (A) Valve Lift Versus Flowrate
(2) Time (B) Flowrate
(3) Overshoot (C) At Short Valve Lift
(4) Notch (D) At Medium Valve Lift
(E) At High Valve Lift
(F) Valve Lift
W1013684
III-S-78
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
III-S-79
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
5. FUEL SYSTEM
[1] GOVERNOR
The engine employs the separated fuel injection
pump in combination with Kubota’s own small multi-
function mechanical governor, which enable more
dependability.
It also employs the torque limiting mechanism to
control the maximum peak torque so that it complies
with the regulations of exhaust gas.
This mechanism maintains engine speed at a
constant level even under fluctuating loads, provides
stable idling and regulates maximum engine speed by
controlling the fuel injection rate.
This engine uses a mechanical governor that
controls the fuel injection rate at all speed ranges (from
idling to maximum speed) by utilizing the balance
between the flyweight’s centrifugal force and spring
tension.
A governor shaft for monitoring engine speed is
independent of the injection pump shaft and rotates at
twice the speed of conventional types, providing better
response to load fluctuation and delivering greater
engine output.
W1013830
At Start
The stop solenoid (energized-to-run type) is powered
to release the stop lever.
As no centrifugal force is applied to flyweight (2), low
tension of start spring (1) permits control rack to move
the starting position, supplying the amount of fuel
required to start the engine.
(1) Start Spring (2) Flyweight
W1013967
III-S-80
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
At Idling
Turn the speed control lever (6) clockwise to idle the
engine. It tensions the governor spring (3) to pull the
fork lever 2 (1).
When the fork lever 2 is pulled, it moves the torque
spring pin (7) and the fork lever 1 (5) in the direction of
the arrow A to restrain the weight. In combination with
the start spring tension, it is balanced with the centrifugal
force of flywheel weight to keep idling.
(1) Fork Lever 2 (5) Fork Lever 1
(2) Start Spring (6) Speed Control Lever
(3) Governor Spring (7) Spring Pin
(4) Flyweight
W1014034
III-S-81
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
To stop engine
When the stop solenoid is turned off, the spring
tension of the solenoid is released, the rod extrudes and
the stop lever moves the control rack in the direction of
the arrow B which stops the engine.
To stop the engine manually, move the external stop
lever to the left.
W1014393
III-S-82
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
III-S-83
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
III-S-84
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
6. TURBOCHARGER SYSTEM
[1] BOOST COMPENSATOR
The boost compensator is controlled by the boost
pressure of the control mechanism which controls
transient smoke caused by oversupply of fuel when the
engine starts and accelerates.
When the boost pressure is lower than working
pressure of the boost actuator (1), it prevents oversupply
of fuel to reduce transient smoke.
When the boost pressure is higher than working
pressure of the boost actuator (1), it controls the supply
of fuel to the equivalent of maximum power / rated speed
output.
The boost compensator adjusting screws (2) are set
and tamper-proof capped in factory, so never take off
the tamper-proof cap and readjust the screws.
(1) Boost Actuator (2) Boost Compensator Adjusting
Screw
W1014569
III-S-85
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
7. INTAKE SYSTEM
[1] INTAKE AIR HEATER
The intake air heater is introduced in order to further
improve the starting performance and to reduce the
white smoke at cold starting.
The intake air heater is mounted on the intake
manifold. In this new construction, there is no need to
arrange any glow plug on the cylinder head. This means
that a multi-valve design can be implemented and that
the starting performance and serviceability are
enhanced.
W1015544
III-S-86
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
Service
III-S-87
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
III-S-88
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
1. TROUBLESHOOTING
Reference
Symptom Probable Cause Solution
Page
Engine Does Not No fuel Replenish fuel
Start Air in the fuel system Vent air
Water in the fuel system Change fuel and
repair or replace fuel
system
Fuel hose clogged Clean or replace
Fuel filter clogged Replace
Excessively high viscosity of fuel or engine oil at Use specified fuel or
low temperature engine oil
Fuel with low cetane number Use specified fuel
Fuel leak due to loose injection pipe retaining nut Tighten retaining nut
Incorrect injection timing Adjust
Fuel camshaft worn Replace
Injection nozzle clogged Repair or replace
Injection pump malfunctioning Repair or replace
Seizure of crankshaft, camshaft, piston, cylinder Repair or replace
or bearing
Compression leak from cylinder Replace head
gasket, tighten
cylinder head screw
and nozzle holder
Improper valve timing Correct or replace
timing gear
Piston ring and cylinder worn Replace
Excessive valve clearance Adjust
Stop solenoid malfunctioning Replace
Starter Does Not Run Battery discharged Charge
Starter malfunctioning Repair or replace
Key switch malfunctioning Replace
Wiring disconnected Connect
W1014322
III-S-89
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
Reference
Symptom Probable Cause Solution
Page
Engine Revolution Is Fuel filter clogged or dirty Replace
Not Smooth Air cleaner clogged Clean or replace
Fuel leak due to loose injection pipe retaining nut Tighten retaining nut
Injection pump malfunctioning Repair or replace
Incorrect nozzle opening pressure Repair or replace
Injection nozzle stuck or clogged Repair or replace
Governor malfunctioning Repair
Turbocharger bearing worn out Replace the
turbocharger
assembly
Turbocharger shaft bent Replace the
turbocharger
assembly
Turbocharger fin or other part damaged due to Replace the
foreign matters turbocharger
assembly
Either White or Blue Excessive engine oil Reduce to specified
Exhaust Gas Is level
Observed Piston ring and cylinder worn or stuck Repair or replace
Incorrect injection timing Adjust
Oil Leak into Exhaust Waste oil pipe clogged or deformed Repair or replace
Pipe or Suction Pipe Turbocharger’s piston ring seal faulty Replace the
turbocharger
assembly
Either Black or Dark Overload Reduce the load
Gray Exhaust Gas Is Low grade fuel used Use specified fuel
Observed
Fuel filter clogged Replace
Air cleaner clogged Clean or replace
Deficient nozzle injection Repair or replace
nozzle
W1014322
III-S-90
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
Reference
Symptom Probable Cause Solution
Page
Deficient Output Incorrect injection timing Adjust
Engine’s moving parts seem to be seizing Repair or replace
Injection pump malfunctioning Repair or replace
Deficient nozzle injection Repair or replace
nozzle
Compression leak Check the
compression
pressure and repair
Gas leak from exhaust system Repair or replace
Air leak from compressor discharge side Repair or replace
Air cleaner dirty or clogged Clean or replace
Compressor wheel turning heavily Replace the
turbocharger
assembly
Excessive Lubricant Piston ring’s gap facing the same direction Shift ring gap
Oil Consumption direction
Oil ring worn or stuck Replace
Piston ring groove worn Replace piston
Valve stem and valve guide worn Replace
Crankshaft bearing and crank pin bearing worn Replace
Oil leaking due to defective seals or packing Replace
Fuel Mixed into Injection pump’s plunger worn Repair or replace
Lubricant Oil Deficient nozzle injection Repair or replace
nozzle
Injection pump broken Replace
Water Mixed into Head gasket defective Replace
Lubricant Oil Cylinder block or cylinder head flawed Replace
Low Oil Pressure Engine oil insufficient Replenish
Oil strainer clogged Clean
Relief valve stuck with dirt Clean
Relief valve spring weaken or broken Replace
Excessive oil clearance of crankshaft bearing Replace
Excessive oil clearance of crankpin bearing Replace
Excessive oil clearance of rocker arm Replace
Oil passage clogged Clean
Different type of oil Use specified type of
oil
Oil pump defective Replace
W1014322
III-S-91
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
Reference
Symptom Probable Cause Solution
Page
High Oil Pressure Different type of oil Use specified type of
oil
Relief valve defective Replace
Engine Overheated Engine oil insufficient Replenish
Fan belt broken or elongated Replace or adjust
Coolant insufficient Replenish
Radiator net and radiator fin clogged with dust Clean
Inside of radiator corroded Clean or replace
Coolant flow route corroded Clean or replace
Radiator cap defective Replace
Overload running Reduce the load
Head gasket defective Replace
Incorrect injection timing Adjust
Unsuitable fuel used Use specified fuel
Battery Quickly Battery electrolyte insufficient Replenish distilled
Discharged water and charge
Fan belt slips Adjust belt tension or
replace
Wiring disconnected Connect
Rectifier defective Replace
Alternator defective Replace
Battery defective Replace
W1014322
III-S-92
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
2. SERVICING SPECIFICATIONS
ENGINE BODY
Item Factory Specification Allowable Limit
Cylinder Head Surface Flatness – 0.05 mm
0.0020 in.
Top Clearance 0.72 to 0.90 mm –
0.0283 to 0.0354 in.
Compression Pressure V3800DI-E2B 3.92 MPa / 2.90 MPa /
250 min1 (rpm) 250 min1 (rpm)
40.0 kgf/cm2 / 29.6 kgf/cm2 /
250 min1 (rpm) 250 min1 (rpm)
569 psi / 421 psi /
250 min1 (rpm) 250 min1 (rpm)
III-S-93
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
Tilt – 1.0 mm
0.039 in.
Valve Spring Setting Load / 63.547 N / 31.5 mm 45.864 N /
Setting Length 6.48 kgf / 31.5 mm 31.5 mm
(Intake) 14.256 lbs / 1.2401 in. 4.68 kgf / 31.5 mm
10.296 lbs /
1.2401 in.
III-S-94
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
Alignment – 0.01 mm
0.00039 in.
Cam Height Intake 37.63 mm 37.13 mm
1.4815 in. 1.4618 in.
III-S-95
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
III-S-96
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
Alignment – 0.02 mm
0.00079 in.
Crankshaft Journal to Crankshaft Bearing Oil Clearance 0.018 to 0.062 mm 0.20 mm
0.0007 to 0.0024 in. 0.0079 in.
III-S-97
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
LUBRICATING SYSTEM
Item Factory Specification Allowable Limit
Engine Oil Pressure At Idle Speed – 49 kPa
0.5 kgf/cm2
7 psi
COOLING SYSTEM
Thermostat Valve Opening 74.5 to 78.5 °C –
Temperature 166.1 to 173.3 °F
Valve Opening 90 °C –
Temperature 194 °F
(Opened
Completely)
Radiator Water Tightness Water tightness at –
specified pressure
137 kPa
1.4 kgf/cm2
20 psi
Radiator Cap Air Leakage 10 seconds or more –
88 o 59 kPa
0.9 o 0.6 kgf/cm2
13 o 9 psi
Fan Belt Tension 10.0 to 12.0 mm / 98 N –
0.394 to 0.472 in. / 98 N
(10 kgf, 22 lbs)
W10135990
III-S-98
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
FUEL SYSTEM
Item Factory Specification Allowable Limit
Injection Timing 0.21 to 0.24 rad –
(12 to 14 °)
before T.D.C.
Pump Element Fuel Tightness – 18.63 MPa
190 kgf/cm2
2702 psi
Delivery Valve Fuel Tightness 10 seconds 5 seconds
18.63 o 17.65 MPa 18.63 o 17.65 MPa
190 o 180 kgf/cm2 190 o 180 kgf/cm2
2702 o 2560 psi 2702 o 2560 psi
Fuel Injection Nozzle Injection Pressure 18.63 to 19.61 MPa –
(1st stage) 190 to 200 kgf/cm2
2702 to 2845 psi
ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
Commutator O.D. 32 mm 31.4 mm
1.2598 in. 1.2362 in.
Mica Undercut 0.5 mm 0.2 mm
0.0197 in. 0.0079 in.
Brush (Starter) Length 18.0 mm 11.0 mm
0.7086 in. 0.4331 in.
Alternator No-load Voltage 14 V at –
4000 min-1 (rpm)
Rotor Coil Resistance 2.8 to 3.3 : –
Slip Ring O.D. 22.7 mm 22.1 mm
0.894 in. 0.870 in.
Brush (Alternator) Length 18.5 mm 5.0 mm
0.728 in. 0.197 in.
Intake Air Heater Resistance Approx. 0.3 : –
(at cold occasion)
W1013973
III-S-99
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
3. TIGHTENING TORQUES
Screws, bolts and nuts must be tightened to the specified torque using a torque wrench, several screws, bolts and
nuts such as those used on the cylinder head must be tightened in proper sequence and the proper torque.
Nominal Unit
Diameter N·m kgf·m ft-lbs N·m kgf·m ft-lbs
M6 7.9 to 9.3 0.80 to 0.95 5.8 to 6.9 9.8 to 11.3 1.00 to 1.15 7.23 to 8.32
M8 17.7 to 20.6 1.8 to 2.1 13.0 to 15.2 23.5 to 27.5 2.4 to 2.8 17.4 to 20.3
M10 39.2 to 45.1 4.0 to 4.6 28.9 to 33.3 48.1 to 55.9 4.9 to 5.7 35.4 to 41.2
M12 62.8 to 72.6 6.4 to 7.4 46.3 to 53.5 77.5 to 90.2 7.9 to 9.2 57.1 to 66.5
W10371750
Screw and bolt material grades are shown by numbers punched on the screw and bolt heads. Prior to
tightening, be sure to check out the numbers as shown below.
Punched number Screw and bolt material grade
None or 4 Standard screw and bolt SS41, S20C
7 Special screw and bolt S43C, S48C (Refined)
W1012705
III-S-100
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
III-S-101
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
III-S-102
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
III-S-103
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
Note
• After adjusting, tighten the lock nut (4) securely.
Valve arrangement
Adjustment cylinder IN. EX
Location of piston
1st * *
III-S-104
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
(A) Deflection
W1021011
III-S-105
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
Caution
• When removing the radiator cap, wait at least ten minutes after the engine has stopped and cooled down.
Otherwise, hot water may gush out, scalding nearby people.
Radiator Cap Air Leakage
1. Set a radiator tester on the radiator cap.
2. Set a radiator tester.
Apply the specified pressure of 88 kPa (0.9 kgf/cm2, 13 psi).
3. Check if the pressure drop to less than 59 kPa (0.6 kgf/cm2, 9
psi) in 10 seconds.
4. If the pressure is less than the factory specification, replace it.
W1021320
III-S-106
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
III-S-107
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
III-S-108
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
Note
• Never try to disassemble the injection pump assembly. For
repairs, you are strongly requested to contact a Kubota-
authorized pump service shop.
(1) Injection Pump Pressure Tester (3) Protection Cover for Jetted Fuel
(2) Injection Nozzle
W1017430
Fuel Tightness of Delivery Valve
1. Remove the engine stop solenoid.
2. Remove the injection pipes.
3. Set a pressure tester to the fuel injection pump.
4. Install the injection nozzle (2) jetted with the proper injection
pressure to the injection pump pressure tester (1).
5. Run the starter to increase the pressure.
6. Stop the starter when the fuel jets from the injection nozzle. After
that, turn the flywheel by the hand and raise the pressure to
approx. 18.63 MPa (190 kgf/cm2, 2702 psi).
7. Now turn the flywheel back about half a turn (to keep the plunger
free). Maintain the flywheel at this position and clock the time
taken for the pressure to drop from 18.63 to 17.65 MPa (from
190 to 180 kgf/cm2, from 2702 to 2560 psi).
8. Measure the time needed to decrease the pressure from 18.63
to 17.65 MPa (from 190 to 180 kgf/cm2, from 2702 to 2560 psi).
9. If the measurement is less than allowable limit, replace the pump
with new one or repair with a Kubota-authorized pump service shop.
10 seconds
18.63 o 17.65 MPa
Factory spec.
190 o 180 kgf/cm2
Fuel tightness of 2702 o 2560 psi
delivery valve 5 seconds
18.63 o 17.65 MPa
Allowable limit
190 o 180 kgf/cm2
2702 o 2560 psi
Note
• Never try to disassemble the injection pump assembly. For
repairs, you are strongly requested to contact a Kubota-
authorized pump service shop.
(1) Injection Pump Pressure Tester (3) Protection Cover for Jetted Fuel
(2) Injection Nozzle
W1017786
III-S-109
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
Caution
• Check the nozzle injection pressure and condition after confirming that there is nobody standing in the
direction the fume goes.
• If the fume from the nozzle directly contacts the human body, cells may be destroyed and blood poisoning
may be caused.
Nozzle Spraying Condition
1. Set the injection nozzle to a nozzle tester, and check the nozzle
spraying condition.
2. If the spraying condition is defective, replace the injection nozzle
assembly or repair at Denso service shop.
(a) Good (b) Bad
W10371670
III-S-110
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
Caution
• To avoid accidental short circuit, be sure to attach the positive cable to the positive terminal before the
negative cable is attached to the negative terminal.
• Never remove the battery cap while the engine is running.
• Keep electrolyte away from eyes, hands and clothes. If you are spattered with it, wash it away completely
with water immediately.
• Keep open sparks and flames away from the battery at all times. Hydrogen gas mixed with oxygen
becomes very explosive.
• IMPORTANT
• If the machine is to be operated for a short time without battery (using a slave battery for starting), use
additional current (lights) while engine is running and insulate terminal of battery. If this advice is
disregarded, damage to alternator and regulator may result.
Battery Voltage
1. Stop the engine.
2. Measure the voltage with a circuit tester between the battery
terminals.
3. If the battery voltage is less than the factory specification, check
the battery specific gravity and recharge the battery.
Battery voltage Factory spec. More than 12 V
III-S-111
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
III-S-112
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
Motor Test
Caution
III-S-113
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
III-S-114
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
(6) Turbocharger
Turbine Side
1. Check the exhaust port (3) and inlet port (5) side of turbine
housing (1) to see if there is no exhaust gas leak.
2. If any gas leak is found, retighten the bolts and nuts or replace
the gasket (2) / (4) / (6) with new one.
(1) Turbine Housing (4) Gasket
(2) Gasket (5) Inlet Port
(3) Exhaust Port (6) Gasket
W1076917
Compressor Side
1. Check the inlet hose (1) of the compressor cover (3) to see if
there is no air leak.
2. Check for loose connections or cracks in the suction side of the
intake hose.
3. If any air leak is found, change the clamp (2) and or inlet hoses.
(1) Inlet Hose (3) Compressor Cover
(2) Clamp
W1077032
Radial Clearance
1. If the wheel contact to the housing, replace the turbocharger
assembly with new one.
W1077353
III-S-115
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
Draining Coolant
III-S-116
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
Caution
• While the engine is running and or just after it stops, the turbocharger is hot, be careful not to touch the
turbocharger.
• NOTE
• When detaching and attaching the turbocharger assembly, be very careful not to allow dust, dirt and other
foreign matter in the oil pipes.
• When the turbocharger assembly has been replace, pour fresh engine oil through the oil filler port of the
turbocharger.
• Before starting the engine, make sure that air cleaner is in position.
Oil Pipe
1. Remove the joint bolt (5) and clamp (4) and take off the pipe 1
(2).
2. Remove the bolts (1) and release the clamp (6).
3. Disconnect the oil pipe 2 (7) and pipe 4 (3).
(When reassembling)
• Pour fresh engine oil through the oil filler port of the
turbocharger.
• Replace the gasket with new one.
• Be careful not to allow dust, dirt and other foreign matters in the
oil pipes.
NOTE
• Tape or plug all openings to prevent foreign matters from
damaging the oil cavities in the turbocharger.
(1) Bolt (5) Joint Bolt
(2) Oil Pipe 1 (6) Clamp
(3) Oil Pipe 4 (7) Oil Pipe 2
(4) Clamp
W1025983
Turbocharger
1. Remove the screw (1) and bolt (3).
2. Take off the turbocharger assembly (2).
(When reassembling)
• Replace the gasket with new one.
(1) Screw (3) Bolt
(2) Turbocharger Assembly
W1078106
III-S-117
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
III-S-118
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
III-S-119
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
III-S-120
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
Valve
1. Remove the valve spring collets (1) after compressing the valve
spring (3) with the valve spring retainer (2).
(When reassembling)
• Install the valve spring with its small-pitch end downward (at the
head side).
• Wash the valve stem and valve guide hole, and apply engine oil
sufficiently.
• After installing the valve spring collets, lightly tap the stem to
assure proper fit with a plastic hammer.
(1) Valve Spring Collet (7) Large Pitch
(2) Valve Spring Retainer (8) Smaller Pitch
(3) Valve Spring (9) Install the spring with its smaller-
(4) Valve Stem Seal pitch end downward (at the head
(5) Arm Bridge side)
(6) Valve
W1053044
III-S-121
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
(4) Thermostat
Thermostat Assembly
1. Remove the thermostat cover mounting screws, and remove the
thermostat cover (1).
2. Remove the thermostat assembly (3).
(When reassembling)
• Apply a liquid gasket (Three Bond 1215 or equivalent) only at the
thermostat cover side of the gasket (2).
• Attach the thermostat with its hole facing toward the air suction
side.
(1) Thermostat Cover (3) Thermostat Assembly
(2) Thermostat Cover Gasket (4) Hole
W1072747
III-S-122
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
III-S-123
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
III-S-124
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
III-S-125
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
III-S-126
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
Governor Lever
1. Remove the speed control lever (1) and the return spring (2).
2. Remove the governor lever assembly (4) from the governor
housing.
3. Remove the start spring (5) and the stop spring (3).
(1) Speed Control Lever (4) Governor Lever Assembly
(2) Return Spring (5) Start Spring
(3) Stop Spring
W1142375
Stop Lever
1. Remove the stop lever (1) and the return spring (2).
2. Remove the stop lever shaft (3).
(1) Stop Lever (3) Stop Lever Shaft
(2) Return Spring
W1143531
III-S-127
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
III-S-128
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
III-S-129
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
III-S-130
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
III-S-131
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
III-S-132
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
Oil Cooler
1. Remove the water pipe (1).
2. Remove the oil filter cartridge (2) and the oil cooler joint screw
(3).
3. Remove the oil cooler (4).
39.2 to 44.1 N·m
Tightening torque Oil cooler joint screw 4.0 to 4.5 kgf·m
28.9 to 32.5 ft-lbs
III-S-133
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
Relief Valve
1. Remove the relief valve retaining screw (1).
2. Remove the relief valve (2), the spring (3) and the packing (4).
68.6 to 78.4 N·m
Relief valve retaining
Tightening torque 7.0 to 8.0 kgf·m
screw
50.6 to 57.9 ft-lbs
III-S-134
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
III-S-135
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
III-S-136
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
III-S-137
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
III-S-138
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
III-S-139
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
Flywheel Housing
1. Remove the flywheel housing.
(When reassembling)
• Tighten the flywheel housing mounting screws with even force
on the diagonal line.
• Make sure the crank cases 1 and 2 are clean. Install them in
position, referring to the flywheel housing’s contoured face.
77.5 to 90.2 N·m
Flywheel housing
Tightening torque 7.9 to 9.2 kgf·m
mounting screw
57.1 to 66.5 ft-lbs
III-S-140
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
III-S-141
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
Crankshaft
1. Remove the main bearing case.
2. Remove the crankshaft.
(When reassembling)
• Reassemble the main bearing case having the same number as
the one engraved on the crankcase, and set the casting mark “F
/ W SIDE” on the main bearing case facing towards the flywheel
side.
• Reassemble the thrust bearing (2), with the oil groove facing
outside, into both side of the fourth main bearing case (1).
• Apply oil to the bearing case screws and tighten them to the
specified torque.
137.3 to 147.1 N·m
Tightening torque Main bearing case screw 14.0 to 15.0 kgf·m
101.3 to 108.5 ft-lbs
III-S-142
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
(11) Starter
Disassembling Motor
1. Disconnect the solenoid switch (3).
2. Remove the 2 through screws (9) and the 2 brush holder lock
screws. Take out the rear end frame (13) and the brush holder
(12).
3. Disconnect the armature (10) and the yoke (11). Remove also
the ball (7) from the tip of the armature.
4. Remove the set of packings (8), the 4 planetary gears and
another packing.
5. Take out the shaft assembly. Take note of the position of the
lever.
IMPORTANT
• Before disconnecting the yoke, put tally marks on the yoke
and the front bracket.
• Take note of the positions of the set of packings and the
setup bolt.
• Apply grease to the gears, bearings, shaft’s sliding part and
ball.
NOTE
• Do not damage to the brush and commutator.
(When reassembling)
• Apply grease (DENSO CO. No.50 or equivalent) to the parts
indicated in the figure.
(1) Gear (8) Set of Packings
(2) Front Bracket (9) Through Bolt
(3) Solenoid Switch (10) Armature
(4) Overrunning Clutch (11) Yoke
(5) Internal Gear (12) Brush Holder
(6) Planetary Gear (13) Rear End Frame
(7) Ball
W1074237
(12) Alternator
Front Bracket
1. Remove the 4 screws (3).
2. Separate the front bracket (1) and the rear bracket (2) from each
other.
IMPORTANT
• Put a tally line on the front bracket and the rear bracket for
reassembling them later.
(1) Front Bracket (3) Screw
(2) Rear Bracket
W1074745
III-S-143
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
Pulley
1. Hold the rotor (base of the claw) in a vise. Loosen the lock nut
using a M24 box wrench.
58.3 to 78.9 N·m
Tightening torque Pulley nut 5.95 to 8.05 kgf·m
43.0 to 58.2 ft-lbs
W1074849
Rotor
1. Remove the 4 screws and detach the bearing retainer.
2. Temporarily install the nut on the pulley screw, and detach the
rotor.
W1074920
Brush
1. When the rotor is detached, the 2 brushes are found to stretch
out of the shaft hole.
W1075045
III-S-144
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
III-S-145
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
[3]SERVICING
(1) Cylinder Head
Top Clearance
1. Remove the cylinder head (remove the cylinder head gasket
completely).
2. Bring the piston to its top dead center fasten 1.5 mm dia. 5 to 7
mm long fuse wires to 3 to 4 spots on the piston top with grease
so as to avoid the intake and exhaust valves and the combustion
chamber ports.
3. Bring the piston to its middle position, install the cylinder head,
and tighten the cylinder head screws to specification. (Head
gasket must be changed to new one).
4. Turn the crank shaft until the piston exceeds its top dead center.
5. Remove the cylinder head, and measure squeezed fuse wires
for thickness.
6. If the measurement is not within the specified value, check the
oil clearance of the crankpin journal and the piston pin.
0.72 to 0.90 mm
Top clearance Factory spec.
0.0283 to 0.0354 in.
(1) Fuse
W1049122
Cylinder Head Surface Flatness
1. Clean the cylinder head surface.
2. Place a straightedge on the cylinder head’s four sides (A), (B),
(C) and (D) and two diagonal (E) and (F) as shown in the figure.
Measure the clearance with a feeler gauge.
3. If the measurement exceeds the allowable limit, correct it with a
surface grinder.
IMPORTANT
• Be sure to check the valve recessing after correcting.
Cylinder head surface 0.05 mm
Allowable limit
flatness 0.0020 in.
W1061323
III-S-146
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
Valve Lapping
1. Apply compound evenly to the valve lapping surface.
2. Insert the valve into the valve guide. Lap the valve onto its seat
with a valve flapper or screwdriver.
3. After lapping the valve, wash the compound away and apply oil,
then repeat valve lapping with oil.
4. Apply prussian blue to the contact surface to check the seated
rate. If it is less than 70 %, repeat valve lapping again.
IMPORTANT
• When valve lapping is performed, be sure to check the valve
recessing and adjust the valve clearance after assembling
the valve.
(1) Correct (3) Incorrect
(2) Incorrect
W1061709
III-S-147
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
III-S-148
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
III-S-149
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
15.973 to 15.984 mm
Rocker arm shaft O.D. Factory spec.
0.6289 to 0.6293 in.
16.000 to 16.018 mm
Rocker arm I.D. for shaft Factory spec.
0.6299 to 0.6306 in.
W1063697
III-S-150
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
23.959 to 23.980 mm
Tappet O.D. Factory spec.
0.9433 to 0.9441 in.
24.000 to 24.021 mm
Tappet guide bore I.D. Factory spec.
0.9449 to 0.9457 in.
W1063847
III-S-151
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
0.049 to 0.189 mm
Factory spec.
Backlash between idle 0.0019 to 0.0074 in.
gear 1 and cam gear 0.22 mm
Allowable limit
0.0087 in.
0.044 to 0.185 mm
Factory spec.
Backlash between idle 0.0017 to 0.0073 in.
gear 1 and idle gear 2 0.22 mm
Allowable limit
0.0087 in.
0.044 to 0.177 mm
Backlash between idle Factory spec.
0.0017 to 0.0070 in.
gear 2 and injection
pump gear 0.22 mm
Allowable limit
0.0087 in.
0.047 to 0.182 mm
Backlash between cam Factory spec.
0.0018 to 0.0072 in.
gear and balancer gear
1 0.22 mm
Allowable limit
0.0087 in.
0.044 to 0.183 mm
Backlash between idle Factory spec.
0.0017 to 0.0072 in.
gear 1 and balancer
gear 2 0.22 mm
Allowable limit
0.0087 in.
W1064048
Idle Gear Side Clearance
1. Set a dial indicator with its tip on the idle gear.
2. Measure the side clearance by moving the idle gear to the front
and rear.
3. If the measurement exceeds the allowable limit, replace the idle
gear collar.
0.15 to 0.30 mm
Factory spec.
0.0059 to 0.0118 in.
Idle gear side clearance
0.9 mm
Allowable limit
0.0354 in.
W1064208
III-S-152
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
III-S-153
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
45.934 to 45.950 mm
Camshaft journal O.D. Factory spec.
1.8084 to 1.8091 in.
46.000 to 46.025 mm
Camshaft bearing I.D. Factory spec.
1.8110 to 1.8120 in.
W1064798
III-S-154
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
III-S-155
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
30.006 to 30.011 mm
Piston pin O.D. Factory spec.
1.1813 to 1.1815 in.
30.031 to 30.046 mm
Small end bushing I.D. Factory spec.
1.1823 to 1.1829 in.
W1065897
Replacing Small End Bushing
(When removing)
1. Press out the used bushing using a small end bushing replacing
tool.
(When installing)
1. Clean a new small end bushing and bore, and apply engine oil
to them.
2. Insert a new bushing onto the tool and press-fit it with a press so
that the seam (1) of bushing position as shown in the figure, until
is flash with the connecting rod.
(1) Seam (A) When Removing
(B) When Installing
(C) 0.26 rad (15 °)
W1066057
III-S-156
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
0.25 to 0.45 mm
Factory spec.
0.0098 to 0.0177 in.
Oil ring
1.25 mm
Allowable limit
0.0492 in.
W1066430
Clearance between Piston Ring and Groove
1. Remove carbon from the ring grooves.
2. Measure the clearance between the ring and the groove with a
feeler gauge or depth gauge.
3. If the clearance exceeds allowable limit, check the new ring
since compression leak and oil shortage result.
4. If clearance still exceeds the allowable limit after replacing the
ring, replace the piston.
0.05 to 0.09 mm
Top ring
0.0020 to 0.0035 in.
0.093 to 0.120 mm
Factory spec. Second ring
0.0037 to 0.0047 in.
0.020 to 0.060 mm
Oil ring
0.0008 to 0.0023 in.
0.15 mm
Top ring
0.0059 in.
0.20 mm
Allowable limit Second ring
0.0079 in.
0.15 mm
Oil ring
0.0059 in.
W1066183
III-S-157
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
(4) Crankshaft
Crankshaft Side Clearance
1. Set a dial indicator with its tip on the end of the crankshaft.
2. Measure the side clearance by moving the crankshaft to the front
and rear.
3. If the measurement exceeds the allowable limit, replace the
thrust bearings.
4. If the same size bearing is useless because of the crankshaft
journal wear, replace it with an oversize one referring to the table
and figure.
0.15 to 0.31 mm
Factory spec.
Crankshaft side 0.0059 to 0.0122 in.
clearance 0.50 mm
Allowable limit
0.0197 in.
(Reference)
• Oversize dimensions of crankshaft journal.
0.2 mm 0.4 mm
Oversize
0.008 in. 0.016 in.
169.1 to 169.15 mm 169.2 to 169.25 mm
Dimension A
6.6575 to 6.6594 in. 6.6614 to 6.6634 in.
29.20 to 29.25 mm 29.40 to 29.45 mm
Dimension B
1.1496 to 1.1515 in. 1.1574 to 1.1594 in.
2.8 to 3.2 mm radius 2.8 to 3.2 mm radius
Dimension C
0.1102 to 0.1260 in. radius 0.1102 to 0.1260 in. radius
(0.8S)
The crankshaft journal must be fine-finished to higher than
W1066738
Crankshaft Alignment
1. Support the crankshaft with V block on the surface plate and set
a dial indicator with its tip on the intermediate journal at right
angle.
2. Rotate the crankshaft on the V block and get the misalignment
(half of the measurement).
3. If the misalignment exceeds the allowable limit, replace the
crankshaft.
0.02 mm
Crankshaft alignment Allowable limit
0.00079 in.
W1067285
III-S-158
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
0.018 to 0.051 mm
Oil clearance between Factory spec.
0.0007 to 0.0020 in.
crankpin and crankpin
bearing 0.20 mm
Allowable limit
0.0079 in.
W1067389
III-S-159
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
III-S-160
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
0.018 to 0.062 mm
Oil clearance between Factory spec.
0.0007 to 0.0024 in.
crankshaft journal and
crankshaft bearing 0.20 mm
Allowable limit
0.0079 in.
(Reference)
• Undersize dimensions of crankshaft journal.
0.2 mm 0.4 mm
Undersize
0.008 in. 0.016 in.
2.8 to 3.2 mm radius 2.8 to 3.2 mm radius
Dimension A
0.1102 to 0.1260 in. radius 0.1102 to 0.1260 in. radius
1.0 to 1.5 mm relief 1.0 to 1.5 mm relief
*Dimension B
0.0394 to 0.0591 in. relief 0.0394 to 0.0591 in. relief
74.777 to 74.790 mm dia. 74.577 to 74.590 mm dia.
Dimension C
2.9440 to 2.9445 in. dia. 2.9361 to 2.9366 in. dia.
(0.8S)
The crankshaft journal must be fine-finished to higher than
*Holes to be de-burred and edges rounded with 1.0 to 1.5 mm
(0.0394 to 0.0591 in.) relief.
W1069159
Replacing Crankshaft Sleeve
1. Remove the used crankshaft sleeve (2).
2. Set the sleeve guide (3) to the crankshaft (1).
3. Heat a new sleeve to a temperature between 150 to 200
<Symbol>×C (302 to 392 <Symbol>×F), and fix the sleeve to the
crankshaft as shown in figure.
4. Press fit the sleeve using the auxiliary socket for pushing (4).
• NOTE
• Mount the sleeve with its largely chamfered surface facing
outward.
(1) Crankshaft (3) Sleeve Guide
(2) Crankshaft Sleeve (4) Auxiliary Socket for Pushing
W1069911
III-S-161
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
(5) Cylinder
Cylinder Wear
1. Measure the I.D. of the cylinder at the six positions (see figure)
with a cylinder gauge to find the maximum and minimum I.D.’s.
2. Get the difference (Maximum wear) between the maximum and
the minimum I.D.’s.
3. If the wear exceeds the allowable limit, bore and hone to the
oversize dimension. (Refer to “Correcting Cylinder”.)
4. Visually check the cylinder wall for scratches. If deep scratches
are found, the cylinder should be bored. (Refer to “Correcting
Cylinder”.)
100.00 to 100.022 mm
Factory spec.
3.9370 to 3.9379 in.
Cylinder Bore I.D.
100.15 mm
Allowable limit
3.9429 in.
III-S-162
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
(7) Starter
Overrunning Clutch
1. Inspect the pinion for wear or damage.
2. If there is any defect, replace the overrunning clutch assembly.
3. Check that the pinion turns freely and smoothly in the
overrunning direction and does not slip in the cranking direction.
4. If the pinion slips or does not rotate in the both directions, replace
the overrunning clutch assembly.
W1075769
III-S-163
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
0.5 mm
Factory spec.
0.0197 in.
Mica under cut
0.20 mm
Allowable limit
0.0079 in.
Brush Wear
1. If the contact face of the brush is dirty or dusty, clean it with
emery paper.
2. Measure the brush length (A) with vernier calipers.
3. If the length is less than the allowable limit, replace the yoke
assembly and brush holder.
18.0 mm
Factory spec.
0.7086 in.
Brush length (A)
11.0 mm
Allowable limit
0.4331 in.
III-S-164
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
Armature Coil
1. Check the continuity across the commutator and armature coil
core with an ohmmeter.
2. If it conducts, replace the armature.
3. Check the continuity across the segments of the commutator
with an ohmmeter.
4. If it does not conduct, replace the armature.
Commutator –
Infinity
Resistance Armature coil core
Commutator segment 0:
W1075693
Field Coil
1. Check the continuity across the lead (1) and brush (2) with an
ohmmeter.
2. If it does not conduct, replace the yoke assembly.
3. Check the continuity across the brush (2) and yoke (3) with an
ohmmeter.
4. If it conducts, replace the yoke assembly.
Lead (1) – Brush (2) 0:
Resistance
Brush (2) – Yoke (3) Infinity
(8) Alternator
Bearing
1. Check the bearing for smooth rotation.
2. If it does not rotate smoothly, replace it.
W1076281
III-S-165
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Engine
Rotor
1. Measure the resistance across the slip rings with an ohmmeter.
2. If the resistance is not the factory specification, replace it.
3. Check the continuity across the slip and core with an ohmmeter.
4. If infinity is not indicated, replace it.
Resistance Factory spec. 2.8 to 3.3 :
W1076422
Slip Ring
1. Check the slip ring for score.
2. If scored, correct with an sand paper or on a lathe.
3. Measure the O.D. of slip ring with vernier calipers.
4. If the measurement is less than the allowable limit, replace it.
22.7 mm
Factory spec.
0.894 in.
Slip ring O.D.
22.1 mm
Allowable limit
0.870 in.
W1076592
Brush Wear
1. Measure the brush length (A) with vernier calipers.
2. If the measurement is less than allowable limit, replace it.
3. Make sure that the brush moves smoothly.
4. If the brush is defective, replace it.
18.5 mm
Factory spec.
0.728 in.
Brush length (A)
5.0 mm
Allowable limit
0.197 in.
III-S-166
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism IV Hydraulic System
I . Hydraulic system
Mechanism Section
A. General . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . IV-M-3
a. Features of the hydraulic system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . IV-M-3
b. Main specifications of hydraulic components . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . IV-M-4
c. Hydraulic components layout . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . IV-M-7
d. Hydraulic Circuit Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . IV-M-8
B. Hydraulic pump . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . IV-M-11
a. Main specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . IV-M-11
b. Outer view . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . IV-M-13
c. Structure. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . IV-M-14
d. Functional parts 1. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . IV-M-15
e. Functional parts 2. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . IV-M-16
f. Pump control circuit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . IV-M-17
g. FYI (For Your Information) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . IV-M-24
C. Control Valve . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . IV-M-26
a. Feature. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . IV-M-26
b. Outline . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . IV-M-26
c. Ccontrol valve . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . IV-M-29
d. Layout, delivery circuit and external pipe flow . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . IV-M-45
e. Inlet section of mono-block valve . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . IV-M-46
f. Center closed valve section (Bucket, S/P 1, Boom). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . IV-M-47
g. Center closed valve section (Arm) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . IV-M-48
h. Arm regenerative flow . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . IV-M-49
i. Swing section (Center closed valve) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . IV-M-50
j. P1 and P2 inlets and travel selector valve . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . IV-M-51
k. Travel section (Center open type) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . IV-M-51
l. P3 inlet and P3 confluence section . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . IV-M-52
m. SP2 section (Mechanical flow adjustment) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . IV-M-53
n. Swivel section . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . IV-M-53
o. P3 bypass confluence valve. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . IV-M-54
p. LS bleed . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . IV-M-55
D. Control valve circuit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . IV-M-56
a. Control valve hydraulic circuit diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . IV-M-56
b. Control valve hydraulic circuit in traveling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . IV-M-57
c. Control valve hydraulic circuit under LS system control without traveling . . . . . . . IV-M-58
d. Control valve P3 hydraulic circuit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . IV-M-59
e. Control valve P3 confluence hydraulic circuit. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . IV-M-60
f. Control valve P3 bypass circuit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . IV-M-61
g. Control valve high-pressure selection function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . IV-M-62
h. Control valve AI signal hydraulic circuit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . IV-M-63
i. FYI (For Your Information) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . IV-M-64
IV-M-1
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism IV Hydraulic System
IV-M-2
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism IV Hydraulic System
A.General
a. Features of the hydraulic system
o. Maiin feature points Feature contents
hree pump system Travel: P1 right travel, P2 left travel
ne cylin er bloc ith Front attachment control: P1 and P2 confluence for LS circuit
t o eli ery ports. (Arm, bucket, SP1, boom, swing)
Travel + front attachment control: P1 right travel, P2 left travel
P3: To front attachment LS circuit
P3 pump: Swivel, dozer, SP2
ontrol al e Monoblock I18 (Arm, bucket, SP1, boom)
ombination al e bloc LS I14 (Swing, Option: two-piece boom, angle dozer)
Open I14 (Travel, SP2, dozer, swivel)
3 System pressure Travel: 29.4 MPa, 300 kgf/cm2, 4267 psi
( oost pressure for tra el)
LS system front attachment: 27.4 MPa, 280 kgf/cm2, 3983 psi
P3: 20.6 MPa, 210 kgf/cm2, 2987 psi
Travel + front attachment control: Travel: 29.4 MPa, 300 kgf/cm2,
4267 psi, front attachment: 20.6 MP, 210 kgf/cm2, 2987 psi
u illiary port (Ma flo SP1: Electronic control for maximum flow limit
limit) SP2: CV pilot primary pressure chamber s mechanical stopper for
maximum flow limit
ll hy raulic pilot control Safety ensured by lever lock in all sections
(Residual pressure released by accumulator)
6 Shoc less al e for boom To ease shocks in moving up and down the boom
cylin er Thin-bladed orifice with pressure compensation
With spool circuit to release return pressure in switching
7 Stan ar e uippe ith With overload preventive switch
hol ing al e Manual control type
egati e s i el Brake released at left/right swivel and with arm crowded, swivel
(High-pressure selector brake activated otherwise
al e timer-controlle Brake activated in 5 seconds
al e)
9 S i el re erse pre enti e To prevent shaking just after swivel
al e
0 ra el negati e bra e To prevent traveling slipage on slope
ra el pilot al e With damper and travel alarm detection port
ressure regulating Pressure regulated 0.07 MPa, 0.7 kgf/cm2, 10.2 psi at pressure
hy raulic tan
side, 0.005 MPa, 0.05 kgf/cm2, 0.73 psi at suction side
Contamination level reduced (tank breathing reduced)
3 High pressure hose an ORS (O ring fitting)
hose oint With socket except suction port
ccumulator Main aim : Relieve residual pressure in the system.
IV-M-3
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism IV Hydraulic System
IV-M-4
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism IV Hydraulic System
IV-M-5
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism IV Hydraulic System
IV-M-6
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism IV Hydraulic System
(17)
(7)
(26)
(25)
(24)
(23)
(22)
(18) (21)
(20)
IV-M-7
ޓ
ޓ ޓ ޓ ޓ
IV-M-8
ޓ
ޓ ޓ ޓ ޓ
IV-M-9
ޓ
ޓ ޓ ޓ ޓ
IV-M-10
.Hydraulic pump
a. Main specifications
1 Pump displacement (CC rev) 36 2 33 8.1
Pump flow rate (L min) 72 2 67 16 L min (19.0 2 17.7 4.23 PM)
2 Stand y flow rate (L min) 22 L min (5.81 PM)
3 Construction P1, P2 Split flow of varia le displacement piston pump
P3 P ( ear pump)
P4 P ( ear pump)
4 Rated speed 2000 rpm
5 LS flow control LS control valve Differential pressure 1.5 MPa
ngine rpm proportional control at P4
Idling at rated flow rate out 60 70
6 Horsepower control PC horsepower control valve With P3 horsepower shift
Without small-diameter piston (self-tilting moment)
P1 P2 pressure verage pressure y aperture
7 Construction earing Cradle
Shoe plate Spherical
Large-diameter piston (with shoe)
IV-M-11
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism IV Hydraulic System
IV-M-12
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism IV Hydraulic System
b. Outer view
IV-M-13
c. Structure
P1, P2
(Variable displacement pump + Horsepower control + LS control)
P3
Fixed gear pump (Swivel, dozer SP2)
P4 : Pilot pump
(Used also for LS engine rpm proportional control)
IV-M-14
d. Functional parts 1
(1) (2)
Function :
The force to tilt the tilting swash plate toward the
L-d large flow side is produced by repositioning the
L turning center of the tilting swash plate and generat-
ing the self-tilting moment. (The small-diameter pis-
Ms
L+d ton adopted on KX121-3, KX161-3 is not used
here.) The tilt return spring is applied to assist at low
L pressure.
IV-M-15
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism IV Hydraulic System
e. Functional parts 2
(1) (3)
(2)
S flo control al e
Basically common with KX121-3, KX161-3
Orifice and control differential pressure setting
different, however
IV-M-16
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism IV Hydraulic System
( ump structure)
P1, P2 : Variable displacement pump + PC horsepower control + LS flow control (Q1 = Q2) (Travel, arm,
bucket, SP1, boom, swing, AUX)
: Split flow
: Spherical valve plate
: Cradle bearing
: No small-diameter piston provided (self-pressing moment used)
P3 : Gear pump (swivel, dozer, SP2) (Used for LS system in using the travel and LS control)
P4 : Gear pump ((Pilot pump) and to use also for LS engine rpm proportional control)
( ump control)
1. Horsepower: Orifice-controlled P1 + P2 average pressure to make the power double, instead of gener-
ating the P1 + P2 horsepower with a stepped piston. P3 also controlled together.
2. Engine rpm gain control: P4 pilot pump s discharge throttled, resulting in differential pressure. LS differ-
ential pressure modified accordingly. (Same mechanism as on KX121-3S/D and KX161-3S/D)
3. Introduction of response improvement check valve (LS flow control valve bypassed) at P3 under pres-
sure. In this way, swivel horsepower control response quicker and engine drop reduced.
4. Tilting swash plate s moment for larger flow rate controlled by repositioning the turning center of the
swash plate and generating the self-tilting moment. (The small-diameter piston on KX121-3S/D and
KX161-3S/D is abolished out.) Tilt moment assist spring also adopted to boost the tilting moment at low
pressure.
IV-M-17
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism IV Hydraulic System
1. LS control 1
PPS = PLS + PF + 'PP
P3 Pav Pmax Pc
Pps
Pmax
Pc
Ppa
Pp
Ppb
PLS
LS-control valve
When the machine is working under the stable load condition, load sensing pressure (PLS) and pump swash
plate angle are at certain stable values.
Therefore, LS control spool stays balancing according to the following equation.
Then the control pin stays at the stable position to keep the swash plate for required pump delivery.
IV-M-18
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism IV Hydraulic System
2. LS control 2
PPS PLS + PF + 'PP
P3 Pav Pmax Pc
Pps
Pmax
Pc
Ppa
Pp
Ppb
PLS
LS-control valve
When an operator shifts the control lever to the inching movement of the front attachment, main spool notch
opening area of the control valve is regurated to limit the oil flow through.
Therefore, pressure value before the spool notch (PPS) becomes comparatively higher and the pressure dif-
ference between PPS (pressure before the spool notch) and PLS (pressure after the spool notch) increases
momentarily.
Thus, pressure balance changes to shift down the LS control spool, which leads the high pressure (Pmax) to
push the control pin and decrease the swash plate angle.
IV-M-19
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism IV Hydraulic System
3. LS control 3
PPS PLS + PF + 'PP
P3 Pav Pmax Pc
Pps
Pmax
Pc
Ppa
Pp
Ppb
PLS
LS-control valve
When an operator shifts the control lever to full stroke, main spool notch area of the control valve opens fully.
Therefore, pressure value before the spool notch (PPS) becomes comparatively lower and the pressure dif-
ference between PPS (pressure before the spool notch) and PLS (pressure after the spool notch) decreases
momentarily.
Thus, pressure balance changes to shift up the LS control spool, which leads the control pressure (Pc) from
the control pin to dump and increase the swash plate angle.
IV-M-20
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism IV Hydraulic System
Operating condition :
Within the horsepower zone P3 Pav Pmax Pc
Low Pc pressure, LS control
zone, 0~100k
P1+P2
= 80k, P3 = 0
2
Pps
Pmax
Pc
Ppa
Pp
Ppb
PLS
LS-control valve
Under this operating condition, average pressure ( P1+P2 ) is being applied the horse power spool to push
the spring to increase the swash plate angle. 2
The control spool notch is opened the Pc port from the control pin chamber to tank.
IV-M-21
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism IV Hydraulic System
Operating condition :
Within the horsepower zone P3 Pav Pmax Pc
Low Pc pressure, LS control
zone, 0~250k
P1+P2
= 200k, P3 = 0
2
Pps
Pmax
Pc
Ppa
Pp
Ppb
PLS
LS-control valve
P1+P2
Under this operating condition, average pressure ( 2 ) is being applied the horse power spool to push in
the right direction and opens the oil passage of Pmax port to Pc port.
This pressure oil is delivered to the control pin and push the swash plate, balancing against the horse power
spool via two springs.
IV-M-22
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism IV Hydraulic System
Operating condition :
Horse power control zone P3 Pav Pmax Pc
P1+P2
= 150k
2
P3 = 200k
Pps
Pmax
Pc
Ppa
Pp
Ppb
PLS
LS-control valve
Under this heavy load operating condition, average pressure ( P1+P2 ) and P3 pressure are being applied the
horse power spool to open the oil passage from Pmax to Pc. 2
This control pressure is also applied to the control pin to decrease the swash plate angle, preventing the
engine stall.
IV-M-23
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism IV Hydraulic System
F
Large-diameter piston
for control L2
L1
M
Tilting center
From this equation, the small-diameter piston with a counterclockwise moment has been left out.
F
Large-diameter piston
L2
for control = L2
L1
L1
Tilting center
Small-diameter piston
Clockwise moment of the cylinder block
= (L2 x F - L1 x F) x cosT
The small-diameter piston has been needed in order to make for greater tilting. (On the variable dis-
placement type except for LS, a large spring has been employed instead of the small-diameter piston.)
IV-M-24
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism IV Hydraulic System
P3 P1 + P2 max(P1, P2) Pc
2
A1Approx. I3.8
T
A2Approx. I9.0
A2Approx. I3.0
F3 F4
Pin Spool
P1 + P2
2
Pmax Pc F5
P3
(Independent of horse power control)
(Tilting moment assist spring)
F1 = P3 u (A1 A2)
P P2
F2 = 1 u A2
2
F 1 + F2 = F3 F 4
F3 = K3 u F D
F3 = K4 u (F L4)
IV-M-25
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism IV Hydraulic System
C.Control Valve
a. Feature
1 Section composition Center open valve (I14): 3-gang; Swivel, dozer, SP2
P3 confluence valve (I14)
Center open valve (I14): 2-gang; Travel left and right
Travel selector valve (I18)
Center closed valve (LS) (I18): 4-gang monoblock; Arm, bucket, SP1, boom
Center closed valve (LS) (I14): 1-gang; Swing
Center closed valve (LS) (other spec.) (I14): 2-gang; Future option Angle blade, 2-piece boom
2 Maximum load pressure High pressure selection = Check valve + LS bleed orifice (I0.5)
selection (system change)
3 Spare port SP1 maximum flow limit: By proportional valve
SP1 flow rate: 100 L/min ,26.4 GPM
SP2 maximum flow limit: Mechanical stopper
SP2 flow rate: 67 L/min, 17.7 GPM
4 Signal circuit AI signal: PP1
Travel control signal: PP2 (P1 and P2 to the left or right travel section)
LS control signal: PP3
P3 pump flow to join the LS system circuit by PP2 + PP3 (travel + LS front system control)
5 Travel speed change Similar to a variable displacement pump system (speed change by P3 horsepower shift)
when using the dozer
6 Traveling Left/right travel pumps acting independently
7 Others Boom s anti-drift valve: None (Leak reduction thanks to the holding valve)
b. Outline
(1) Hydraulic circuit
1 Three-pump LS Front attachment (Boom, arm, bucket, swing, SP1) P1 + P2
Traveling P1, P2
Travel + Front attachment Travel : P1, P2
Front attachment : P3
Swivel: Dozer, SP2 P3
2 Pressure Travel 29.4 MPa, 300 kgf/cm2, 4267 psi
Front attachment 27.4 MPa, 280 kgf/cm2, 3983 psi
Swivel, dozer, SP2 (Service port 2) 20.6 MPa, 210 kgf/cm2, 2987 psi
Travel + Front attachment Travel : 29.4 MPa, 300 kgf/cm2, 4267 psi
Front attachment : 20.6 MPa, 210 kgf/cm2, 2987 psi
3 Checking the Main back-pressure check valve 0.4 MPa, 4.1 kgf/cm2, 58.0 psi
back pressure
Oil cooler back-pressure check valve 0.1 MPa, 1.0 kgf/cm2, 14.5 psi
4 Overload relief Arm (bottom) 30.4 MPa, 310 kgf/cm2, 4410 psi
Arm (R), boom (B/R), bucket (B/R) 31.4 MPa, 320 kgf/cm2, 4555 psi
Dozer (B) 27.5 MPa, 280 kgf/cm2, 3990 psi
Dozer (R) 11.8 MPa, 120 kgf/cm2, 1712 psi
SP1 (Service port 1) 20.6 Mpa, 210 kgf/cm2, 2987 psi
5 Others Swing (R) Anti-void
SP2, swing (B) Stop valve
IV-M-26
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism IV Hydraulic System
IV-M-27
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism IV Hydraulic System
IV-M-28
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism IV Hydraulic System
c. Ccontrol valve
1. Overall view of control valve
Thread depth 20
Machine Front
Tightening torque
Swing
Tightening torque
Two ID grooves
Boom
S/P1
Bucket
Arm
Tightening torque
Tightening torque
8.8 11N. m (8 locations)
(8 locations) One ID groove
Travel
Confluence valve
S/P2
P3 bypass
One ID groove
Tightening torque
(4 locations)
Standard machine
Thread depth 20
IV-M-29
ID No. Part name Q’ty Remarks ID No. Part name Q’ty Remarks 2. Control valve specifications
1 51 1. Maximum flow rate: P1, P2; 72 L/min, P3; 66 L/min
2 52 2. Maximum pressure: P1, P2; 29.4 MPa, P3; 20.6 MPa
3 Valve housing 1 53 3. Operating oil temperature range: 253 to 368 °K (-20 to 100°C)
4 Relief valve kit 1 A1 30.4 0.3MPa at 5L/min 54 O-ring 1 JISB2401, 1A, G70 4. Operating hydraulic oil type: ISO VG46 or equivalent
5. Main relief vale pressure setting: P1, P2 (travel independent valve); 29.4 0.3 MPa at 43 L/min
5 Spool 1 55 O-ring 1 JISB2401, 1A, G75
P LS ; 27.4 0.3 MPa at 48 L/min
6 Spool 1 56 O-ring 1 JISB2401, 1B, P7 P3; 20.6 0.3 MPa at 66 L/min
7 Spool 1 57 Spring seat 1 6. Unload valve pressure setting: 2.45 0.1 MPa at 26 L/min
8 Spool 1 58 7. Overload relief valve pressure set- Arm A1; 30.4 0.3 MPa at 5 L/min
9 Cap 4 59 ting: B1; 31.4 0.3 MPa at 5 L/min
Bucket A2; 31.4 0.3 MPa at 5 L/min
10 Cap 4 60 Tie-rod 4
B2; 31.4 0.3 MPa at 5 L/min
11 Spool end 4 61 Tie-rod 4 S/P A3; 20.6 0.3 MPa at 5 L/min
12 Spring 4 62 Nut 8 B3; 20.6 0.3 MPa at 5 L/min
13 Spring seat 8 63 Spool section assembly 1 Swing Boom A4; 31.4 0.3 MPa at 5 L/min
14 Plug 8 64 Outlet housing 1 Outlet B4; 31.4 0.3 MPa at 5 L/min
15 Spool 1 65 Spool section assembly 1 Travel independent valve Blade AK4; 27.4 0.3 MPa at 5 L/min
BK4; 11.8 0.3 MPa at 5 L/min
16 Spool 1 66 Spool section assembly 1 Travel
8. Pilot air bleeding area Swivel, dozer, travel, swing, S/P2, arm, S/P1,
17 Poppet 4 67 Spool section assembly 1 Travel bucket, boom
18 Plug assembly 3 68 Spool section assembly 1 Confluence valve 9 Equipped with S/P2 spool stroke adjustment mechanism: Adjustable range; 2 8 mm
19 Poppet 1 69 Spool section assembly 1 S/PS 10 Pump LS control pressure difference setting: 1.5 MPa
20 Spring 1 70 Spool section assembly 1 Dozer 11. Genuine Kubota part code: RO809-61131
21 Plug assembly 1 71 Spool section assembly 1 Swivel
22 Plug assembly 6 72 Outlet section assembly 1 P3 bypass valve Tightening torque for aluminum cap/port joint (pipe)
23 O-ring 16 73 Relief valve kit 5 B1,A2,B2,A4,B4 Port size PF1/4 Port name Port size
24 Plug 8 31.4 0.3MPa at 5L/min Ports applied pa5, pb5, T1 PF1-1/4
25 Poppet 8 74 Relief valve kit 3 A3,B3,AK4 pak1 2, pak 4 5, pbk 1 2, pbk 4 5 P1, P2, T2, P PF3/4
26 Spring 8 20.6 0.3MPa at 5L/min Recommended tighten- 34.3 N m A1 A4, B1 B4 7/8-14UNF
27 Spool 1 75 Relief valve kit 1 BK4 ing torque P3, P4, A5, B5, PF1/2
28 Spool 1 11.8 0.3MPa at 5L/min Maximum torque 39.2 N m AK1 AK5, BK1 BK5, T3
29 O-ring 8 JISB2401,1A, P26 76 Relief valve kit 2 P1,P2 Thread breaking torque 44.1 N m PB1 , PB2 PF3/8
30 Plug assembly 1 29.4 0.3MPa at 43L/min Conditions Standard-size joint (threaded-part Pa1 Pa5, Pb1 Pb5, PF1/4
31 Relief valve kit 1 P(L5) 27.4 0.3MPa at 48L/min 77 Relief valve kit 1 P3 length 12) Pak1 Pak5, Pbk1 Pbk5,
32 Spool 1 20.6 0.3MPa at 66L/min Remarks Be careful not to apply any torque over PP1 PP3, PPS, PLS, PAI,
maximum one. PF1, PF2, PT, Dr1, Dr2, Pbu1
33 Plug 1 78 Shut-off valve assembly 3 AK3, BK3, A5
34 Stopper 1 79 Anti-void valve assem- 1 B5
bly
35 Set-screw 1 JISB1177, M8x25L
36 Nut 1 JISB1181, M8
37 Spring 1 Others
Main spool stroke (mm)
IV-M-30
3. Swing section
Tightening torque
Four ID grooves
Section A-A
IV-M-31
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism IV Hydraulic System
Section J-J
Boom
S/P1
Arm
Bucket
5.7
Section A-A
Section K-K
IV-M-32
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism IV Hydraulic System
Tightening torque
(8 locations)
Section B-B
Tightening torque
Tightening torque
(2 locations)
IV-M-33
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism IV Hydraulic System
PLS
(6 locations)
Two ID grooves without filter
Tightening torque
(4 locations)
Tightening torque
Section D-D
5. Boom
Tightening torque
(2 locations)
Section E-E
IV-M-34
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism IV Hydraulic System
6. S/P1
Tightening torque
(2 locations)
Section F-F
7. Bucket
Tightening torque
(2 locations)
Section G-G
IV-M-35
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism IV Hydraulic System
8. Arm
Tightening torque
(2 locations)
Section H-H
(2 locations)
One ID groove Tightening torque
Tightening torque
Tightening torque
Tightening torque
Section I-I
IV-M-36
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism IV Hydraulic System
View X
Tighten up until the plug breaks down (M4).
Breaking torque: About 7 N-m (reference)
View X
Tightening torque
(2 locations)
Tighten up until the plug breaks down (M6). Tightening torque: 19-22 N-m
Breaking torque: About 15 N-m (reference) Apply loctite ( 271) to the threads. (KES2237 Class II)
Section B-B
IV-M-37
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism IV Hydraulic System
10.Travel, R section
Travel upstream (next to travel independent valve)
Tightening torque
IV-M-38
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism IV Hydraulic System
11.Travel, L section
Travel downstream (next to confluence valve)
IV-M-39
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism IV Hydraulic System
12.Combined valve
No O-ring is installed around this surface
Tightening torque
Two ID grooves
IV-M-40
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism IV Hydraulic System
13.S/P2 valve
IV-M-41
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism IV Hydraulic System
14.Dozer section
IV-M-42
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism IV Hydraulic System
15.Swivel section
IV-M-43
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism IV Hydraulic System
One ID groove
Section A-A
IV-M-44
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism IV Hydraulic System
(1)
(2)
(3)
(6)
(4) (5)
IV-M-45
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism IV Hydraulic System
(5)
(1)
(4)
(3)
IV-M-46
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism IV Hydraulic System
(1)
(8)
(3)
(2)
(7)
(6)
(5)
(4)
IV-M-47
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism IV Hydraulic System
(1)
(2)
(3)
(7)
(6)
(5)
(4)
IV-M-48
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism IV Hydraulic System
(2)
(1)
(3)
(4)
(10)
(5)
(6) (9)
(7) (8)
(1) Spool shift direction at arm crowding regeneration
(2) PC flow
(3) PC flow + Regenerative flow
(4) Regenerative flow
(5) Tank flow
(6) Regenerative spool
(7) Relief, unload section
(8) Tank circuit
(9) Unload valve
(10) LS, main
IV-M-49
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism IV Hydraulic System
(6)
IV-M-50
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism IV Hydraulic System
(9)
(3) (5)
(4) (6) (7)
(8)
(1) P2 inlet
(2) Signal circuit to pump PPS
(3) Tank circuit
(4) To left-travel P circuit
(5) Tank circuit
(6) To Travel Right
(7) When traveling
(8)
(9) Travel selector signal circuit
(10) P1 inlet
(1) (2)
IV-M-51
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism IV Hydraulic System
(2)
(8)
(3) (12)
(7)
(11)
(10)
Travel + LS system control to get the (1) Tank circuit to swivel motor and oil cooler
spool switched and the P3 center cir- (2) LS system action signal inlet port
cuit and circuit (A) interconnected. (External pipe)
(3) Delivery port for travel detection (PP2)
LS system signal pressure to go to (4) AI signal circuit
pressure receiver face a2, and travel (5) Circuit (A): LS system delivery circuit
signal pressure to a1. (6) P3 center circuit
Areas a1 and a2 equal to each other. (7) Travel detection signal circuit
(8) P3 confluence spool
When not switched: Tank circuit open and no
flow to LS system
When switched: Tank circuit closed and flow
to LS system
(9) P3 delivery circuit
(10) Pressure receiver a2
(11) Pressure receiver a1
(12) Pilot primary pressure
IV-M-52
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism IV Hydraulic System
(1)
(5)
(3) (4)
(2)
n. Swivel section
(5)
(1)
IV-M-53
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism IV Hydraulic System
(7)
(1)
(6)
(2)
(3)
(5)
(4)
(1) To AI pressure switch
(2) AI aperture
(3) AI signal delivery (PP1)
(4) P3 bypass confluence valve
(5) Drain
(6) P3 bypass circuit to monoblock P2
(7) Boom up signal
IV-M-54
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism IV Hydraulic System
p. LS bleed
(9)
(8)
(1)
(7)
(6)
(5)
(2)
(3) (4)
IV-M-55
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
D.Control valve circuit
a. Control valve hydraulic circuit diagram
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism
(2) (3)(4)
eha ior
When the travel is selected, the travel selector valve switches on to sup-
ply oil from the P1 or P2 pump. The PPS signal pressure ecomes e ual
to the tank pressure. When PLS PPS Tank pressure, the pump flow
rate gets ma imized.
(1)
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism
IV-M-60
(1) P3 confluence valve
(2) P3 delivery port
eha ior
(3) Travel select signal detection pressure from P4 pump
When the travel is selected and the LS system is operated, the oil is sup-
(4) P1 pump
plied from the P1 or P2 pump for the travel system (The P1 and P2 pumps
(5) P2 pump
give their maximum flow rate within the horsepower range.) The P3 selec-
(6) CV internal signal detection pressure from P4 pump
tor valve serves for the LS system in order to supply the oil from the P3
(7) LS system control detection signal
pump. (The P3 pump is of fixed displacement type to provide a constant
flow rate. Extra oil is let out through the unload valve.)
IV Hydraulic System
f. Control valve P3 bypass circuit
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism
(1)
IV-M-61
(3)
(1) Check valve
(2) P3 bypass confluence valve
Function
(3) Confluence orifice
When the swivel, boom, (arm) and (bucket) are activated at once, the boom-up pilot pressure works
(4) Boom up signal
to switch the P3 bypass confluence valve. (The boom pilot pressure joins at 2.2 MPa.) The swivel P3
pump branches the flow for the boom to assist in moving up the boom. When the swivel pressure is
greater than the boom operating pressure (at a start of swivel), the confluence occurs.
As the swivel pump pressure drops, the variable displacement pump’s horsepower characteristic
varies accordingly, which increases the flow rate from this valve. With a drop in the swivel starting
pressure, the swivel does not speed up too high. This way, the boom can be moved up speedily
compared with the swivel rate.
IV Hydraulic System
g. Control valve high-pressure selection function
(4) (3) (2) (1)
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism
I18 (19)
(16) I14
(14) (15)
(20) (21) (22)
hanging the high-pressure select system (1) To cylinder (8) PLS signal (16) PLS signal (to pump)
Formerly, the high-pressure side was selected (2) Pressure compensat- (9) Tank circuit (17) PLS signal aperture
ing valve (10) PLS signal aperture (18) PLS signal bleed aperture
by a high-pressure selector valve ( ). On the (3) PLS signal high-pres- (11) PLS signal (to pump) (19) Pressure compensating valve
new system, the high pressure is introduced by sure select check valve (12) PLS signal bleed aperture (20) PLS signal high-pressure select
the check valve that is incorporated in the pres- (4) Unload valve (13) Pressure compensating valve check valve
(5) P1 pump (14) Boom section (21) Swing section
sure compensating valve. The LS bleeder lets (6) P2 pump (15) PLS signal high-pressure
the high-pressure oil into the tank. (7) PPS signal (to pump) select check valve
IV Hydraulic System
h. Control valve AI signal hydraulic circuit
(1)
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism
(2)
IV-M-63
IV Hydraulic System
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism IV Hydraulic System
to unload valve
(KX080-3)
to unload valve
IV-M-64
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism IV Hydraulic System
(5)
(3) (4)
(2)
B port B port
B port A port
A port A port
CoT
QPC
PoC QPT
PoT
P1
QPC = QP - QP o T
Motion started when the load becomes higher than P (load P)
IV-M-65
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism IV Hydraulic System
b. Specifications
Maximum primary pressure 9.8 MPa 100 kgf/cm2
Secondary pressure 0-4.4 (maximum control pressure) MPa
0-45 kgf/cm2
Allowable back pressure At maximum 0.29 MPa 3 kgf/cm2
Rated flow volume 10 L/min
Operating angle 12.4°
Mass Approx. 7.8 kg per set
Piping For favorable response, the internal diameter and
the length of the pipe should be approx. I8 and 3
mm respectively. To prevent an effect of the back
pressure, return the return oil to the tank directly.
Filter To prevent the spool from being stuck, install a 40-
mesh or more filter at the inlet of the P port.
IV-M-66
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism IV Hydraulic System
c. Structure
IV-M-67
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism IV Hydraulic System
(4)
(1)
(2)
(3)
(6) (5)
(5)
(6)
IV-M-68
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism IV Hydraulic System
d. Function
The damper-embedded pilot valve includes in its main body a damping function to prevent hunting (lever
hunting) in the man-machine system.
The following explains the operation of the damper-embedded pilot valve, separating it into 2 sections: a.
reducing valve and b. operation section damping mechanism based on the hydraulic circuit diagram
below, the assembly cross-section drawing in 31(RCVD8C), 32(RCVD8CC), and the damping operation
explanation drawing in 9. The following figure shows a typical usage of the pilot valve.
(5)
(6)
(1)
(3)
(2) (4)
1.2 When the pilot valve operating section is tilted from the neutral position
As shown in the assembly cross-section drawing, when the cam (420) is rotated clockwise, the push rod
(214) at the port 1 is pressed downward, which pushed the spool downward with the help of the washer 1,
the spring seat, the secondary-pressure-setting spring (324), the washer 2 (217), and the washer 3 (313).
As a result, the port P and the port 1 are joined each other and the oil supplied from the pilot pump starts to
flow into the port 1, generating a flow pressure.
When the pressure at the port 1 increases to a pressure equivalent to the force of the secondary-pressure-
setting spring, having been set by the tilted operating section, the oil pressure applied to the spool and the
spring force are kept in balance, which keeps the port 1 outlet pressure constant.
Since the spool at the port 2 remains neutral, the return oil from the control valve flows out through the tank
port T.
Depending on the specifications, the push rod touches the top of the spool directly when the operating sec-
tion is tilted fully, which forcefully pushes down the spool, joining the port P and the outlet port, resulting in an
equal pressure at both ports.
IV-M-69
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism IV Hydraulic System
2.2 When the operating section is tilted from the neutral position (Refer to the damping operation
explanation drawing (1))
As you see in the drawing, when the cam is rotated clockwise, the push rod at the port 1 is pressed down-
ward and the piston moves downward.
At this moment, the oil in the damping piston chamber passes out through the orifice in the piston, producing
a pressure used for damping.
On the other hand, the push rod at the port 2 is moved upward by the damping spring through the piston.
At this moment, the oil in the tank room is absorbed into the damping piston chamber through the 3 ball
check valve portions (using the ball (225) and the bush(223)).
The oil outside the piston chamber flows through the path that joins with the port T at the top of the casing.
2.3 When fully tilted operating section is tilted in reverse direction (Refer to the damping operation
explanation drawing (2))
In the operation explanation drawing, if the cam, having been fully tilted clockwise, is tilted anticlockwise, the
push rod at the port 2 is pushed downward and the piston moves downward. At this moment, as in the case
above, the oil inside the damping piston passes out through the orifice in the piston, producing a pressure
used for damping.
On the other hand, the push rod at the port 1 is moved upward by the return spring (335) and the damping
spring.
As in the case above, the oil in the tank room is absorbed into the damping piston chamber through the 3
ball check valve portions (using the ball (225) and the bush (223)). The oil outside the piston chamber flows
through the path that joins to the tank port from the casing top.
In other words, the damping force is generated in both cases when the operating section is tilted from the
neutral position to the fully tilted position and from the fully tilted position to the neutral position.
3.2 When the pilot valve operating section is tilted from the neutral position
When the one secondary pressure port generate the pressure, the ball(192) is pressed
to the other secondary pressure port and closed the port. The shuttle valve outlet
port pressure is the same as the one secondary pressure port. In other words, the
higher secondary pressure is selected and output from the shuttle valve outlet port.
IV-M-70
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism IV Hydraulic System
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
IV-M-71
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism IV Hydraulic System
Lever stroke state and the operation when the lever is tilted in reverse direction
(6)
(5)
(4)
(1)
(3)
(2)
(1) When the lever is tilted from the neutral position to the reverse position, the push rod is pushed upward
by the damping spring ( Operation direction)
(2) The oil in the T line is absorbed into the damper room through the 3 ball check valve portions.
If the lever is tilted in reverse direction from to o, the left piston immediately acts as a damper piston
The damping force is generated in both directions
(3) The oil inside the piston chamber passes out through the orifice. The pressure generated at this
moment is used for damping pressure ( Operation direction)
(4) The oil outside the piston chamber flows through the pass that joins to the tank port at the top of the
casing. ( Operation direction)
(5) Full stroke
(6) Neutral
IV-M-72
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism IV Hydraulic System
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
Tank port
PP PP
PS PS
IV-M-73
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism IV Hydraulic System
F. Swivel motor
a. General
1. Swivel motor outer view
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5) (6)
(7)
(8)
IV-M-74
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism IV Hydraulic System
IV-M-75
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism IV Hydraulic System
IV-M-76
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism IV Hydraulic System
A: Counterbalance valve
B: Delay valve
C: Check valve
D: Shock-absorbing valve
IV-M-77
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism IV Hydraulic System
2. Relief valve
Function 1
A
When the motor gets started:
When the motor gets started, the inertial load becomes A1
greater, so that the pressure of the oil required for
acceleration rises. If this oil pressure has reached the
preset level of the counterbalance valve, the counter-
balance valve is activated and the oil returns to the port
M2.
In this way, the motor starts running, while the pressure
is balanced by the counterbalance valve. With the rpm
increasing, the balancing rate decreases until finally
the balancing does not take place any longer. In this
manner the shock at the startup is absorbed.
IV-M-78
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism IV Hydraulic System
Function 2
This brake valve has a shock-free mechanism and
works in two stages. Section A1 Section A
First stage
When the brake valve is activated, the pressure in
chamber B (P1) is kept lower than that in chamber C.
The pressure in chamber A (P), on the other hand,
becomes higher than that of the incoming oil.
At this time, two forces act on the disc (10). The force F
moves the disc (10) to the left, whereas the force F1
pushes against the seat to the right side.
Because F = P x A, F1 = P1 x A1, P P1 and A A1,
the disc (10) is moved to the left by the force F - F1 .
Thereby, the supply-side circuit starting from the cham-
ber A gets open in order to let the pressure escape.
That is to say, the brake valve is activated at low pres-
sure (about 1/3 of the preset pressure), while the piston
(11) is moved to its stroke end.
Second stage
When the piston (11) has reached the stroke end, the
pressure in chamber B rises and the pressures in the
chambers A and B counterbalance each other. At this
time, the force that moves the disc (10) to the left
becomes P = P1 , which refers to A - A1 . At the
specified pressure setting, the counterbalance valve is
then activated.
IV-M-79
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism IV Hydraulic System
IV-M-80
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism IV Hydraulic System
1. Parking brake ON
Refer to the construction view Fig. 1 .
When the brake releasing hydraulic pressure is cut off, the discs
that are spline-coupled around the cylinder block are pressed on
the brake piston (fixed not to turn itself) by a spring force. The
frictional force works to retain the cylinder block and the case,
which gets the shaft locked.
(1)
( ) bra e release pressure
Fig.
3. Hydraulic timer
Refer to the construction view Fig. 3 .
The hydraulic timer is designed to prevent a drag of the parking brake in braking the swivel motion. While
the swivel inertial force is absorbed by the hydraulic dynamic brake, a delay time is ensured to disable the
parking brake. The delay time is realized by narrowing the orifice to control the flow of the oil coming out of
the brake cylinder chamber.
Keep the motor running and return the control valve to the neutral position. Now the valve switching pres-
sure SH, which is interlocked with the control valve s switching signal, becomes low. The valve acts by the
spring force as shown below. Through this valve, the brake cylinder chamber connects to the drain. (In this
state, the upper swivel structure s energy is converted to thermal energy and absorbed. To do this, the relief
valve, as discussed later, provides for hydraulic dynamic braking effect.) On the other hand, the oil in the
brake cylinder chamber A tends to flow, by the spring force upon the brake piston, toward the disc-pressing
direction. But the flow of the oil out of the brake cylinder chamber is controlled by the orifice of the valve. In a
specified time, therefore, the brake piston comes into contact with the discs for braking effect.
IV-M-81
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism IV Hydraulic System
(7)
(6)
iagram
(1) Shuttle valve switching external signal
pressure SH
(1) (2) (2) Valve switched for main control during this
period
(3) (3) Time zone in which the flow is controlled
by the orifice
(4) (4) Parking brake cylinder chamber pressure
(5) (5) PG feed pressure acting during this period
(6) Parking brake torque
(7) Parking brake released
(8) (8) Timer setting
(7) (9) Parking brake disabled during this period.
(6) No drag allowed.
(10) Swiveling speed
(11) Preset swiveling speed
(11) (12) Acceleration
(9) (10) (13) Constant swiveling speed
(14) Deceleration
(15) Time (t) : 5 1.5 seconds
(15)
IV-M-82
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism IV Hydraulic System
2. Structure
This valve consists of following items.
A) Check valve
B) Flow control valve
C) Sleeve
D) Orifice A (Inside two plugs, I1.0)
E) Orifice B (Inside Cv, I0.6)
(11) (11)Orifice B
(7)
IV-M-83
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism IV Hydraulic System
(1) (3)
(2) (4)
T (11)
(9)
(10)
IV-M-84
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism IV Hydraulic System
3. Function
Hy raulic circuit iagram
ypical nti S i el ac al e
(2) (3) (4) (5) (6) (7)
(8)
(1)
Pv1 T Pv2
(9)
IV-M-85
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism IV Hydraulic System
(Neutral condition)
Check valve stands in center position by
spring force when control valve is not
operated.
(P1 and P2 have same pressure.)
T
(1)
(Braking condition)
Check valve is pushed and block the
passage by brake pressure.
Note :
This brake pressure is generated by the
pumping function of the swivel motor’s
inertia force when the control lever is
T returned to neutral position while swivel-
ing.
(1)
On this stage, swivel motor is turning a
little.
IV-M-86
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism IV Hydraulic System
T
(1)
(2)
(1)
IV-M-87
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism IV Hydraulic System
P2
P1
Without swivel
back prevention valve
Time (P sec.)
At P1 = P2 At P1 P2
P1 P2
P1 P2
P1 and P2 become same pressure P1 and P2 are blocked
and prevent swivel shock. by the valve seat.
IV-M-88
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism IV Hydraulic System
Section A-A
Section B-B
Circuit diagram
Used to select maximum pressure of the pilot signal for left/right swivel and arm crowd.
Used to release the swivel motor’s negative brake at maximum pressure.
Used to release the maximum pressure signal on the timer-controlled valve of the swivel motor first and
then to get the negative brake activated with a delay (about 5 seconds to allow for enough swivel relief).
IV-M-89
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism IV Hydraulic System
Reaction force
Swivel motor
Digging force
arm bottom
left right
If, Moment by digging force Swivel motor negative braking force ; Friction plates might be burned out.
IV-M-90
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism IV Hydraulic System
G.Travel motor
a. General
1. GM motor
This product is a rotary hydraulic actuator. The reduction gears, hydraulic motor, brake valve and parking
brake are compactly integrated in this actuator. It has been developed and manufactured for construction
machinery that requires low-speed rotations and high-level torques. This product is called GM motor in this
manual.
2. Specifications
Characteristics Working condition
Motor type GM09VN-B-21/36-3
User model KX080-3
Gear ratio MAX. 75.4 61.6
Nm Rating 8830 5160/9000
Reduction gears Rating torque
(kgf m) (900) (526/918)
Output speed r.p.m. MAX. 60.0 52.7/31.6
3/rev.
MAX. capacity cm MAX. 36.3 21.3/36.3
MPa MAX. 31.38 29.4
MAX. working pressure
(kgf/cm2) (320) (300)
Hyd. motor MAX. speed r.p.m. MAX. 3600 3245/1944
Flow rate l/min. 72
MPa 1.96 6.86 1.96 6.86
2 speed control pressrue
(kgf/cm2) (20 㧕 (20 70)
Nm MIN. 97.1 97.1
Braking torque
(kgf m) (9.9) (9.9)
Parking brake
MPa MIN. 0.47 0.47
Release pressure
(kgf/cm2) (4.8) (4.8)
MPa 29.4
System pressure
(kgf/cm2) (300)
Note
1. One side ( D1 or D2 ) of the motor drain ports is plugged. When mounting the GM motor to the excava-
tor, connect the drain piping to the upper drain port.
2. The allowable pressure of the motor case is 0.20 MPa (2 kgf/cm2) below. The drain piping should be
properly sized to keep the inner pressure of the motor case is not over 0.20 MPa (2 kgf/cm2).
Allowable surge pressure is 0.69 MPa (7 kgf/cm2).
3. Motor case should be filled with working oil. Use non-pluged drain port for filling. The volume of the work-
ing oil is about 0.5 L.
4. Gear case is filled in advance with oil’s SAE 90 GL4.
5. For mounting GM, use bolts classified JIS B 1501 strength class 12.9. Use of lock compound on bolts
threads is recommended.
6. When neutral, the control valve should be the position of following chart. Chart P A B
3. Motor type
The type of motor is marked on the product label. P R
IV-M-91
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism IV Hydraulic System
b. Outer view
Direction of rotation
Direction (view X) Inlet port Outlet port
Clockwise
Counter clockwise
IV-M-92
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism IV Hydraulic System
c. Structure
1. Basic structure of GM motor
(7)
(1)
(3) (4)
(2)
1) Reduction gears
The speed reducer consists of two sections: first reduction section with spur gears and second reduction
section with pericycloid-toothed differential gears. The high speed of the hydraulic motor is reduced for low-
speed, large-torque rotation.
2) Hydraulic motor
The hydraulic motor is of swash-plate axial piston type. The force of pressure oil coming from the pump is
converted to rotational movement.
3) Brake valve
This valve is equipped with various component valves. It is designed to bring the hydraulic motor to a
smooth stop, to prevent it from running out of control, and to keep off an excessive pressure that would
occur in case of a sudden hydraulic motor halt.
5) Parking brake
This friction disc type brake is integrated with the hydraulic motor.
IV-M-93
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism IV Hydraulic System
2. Sectional view
IV-M-94
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism IV Hydraulic System
Section A-A
Section B-B
IV-M-95
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism IV Hydraulic System
3. Parts list
No. Parts name Q’ty No. Parts name Q’ty
1 Hub 1 106 Shoe 1
IV-M-96
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism IV Hydraulic System
d. Function
1. Reduction gears
1) Function
The speed reducer consists of two sections: first reduction section with spur gears and second reduction
section with pericycloid-toothed differential gears. The high speed of the hydraulic motor is reduced for low-
speed, large-torque rotation.
2) Behavior
2.1 First reduction section
1) The hydraulic motor’s rotary motion is trans-
(9) mitted through the shaft (102) to the input gear
(7) (6) that is coupled with the shaft G (15). The
input gear (6) is in mesh with three spur gears
(7).
The spur gears (7) reduce the speed and
rotate in the opposite direction. The first
reduction section is composed of these input
gear (6) and spur gears (7).
(15) The reduction ratio of this section is calculated
as follows.
i1 = - Zi / Zs
where,i1: First reduction section’s reduction
ratio
Zi: Number of teeth of input gear
Zs: Number of teeth of spur gear
(4) RV gear A
(5) RV gear B
(7) Spur gear
(9) Crankshaft
(23)Needle bearing
(402) (400)Eccentric elements
(5) (401)Rotating
(4) (402)Eccentric movement
IV-M-97
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism IV Hydraulic System
(1) Hub
Movement at half-turn (180°) (17)Pin
(4) RV gear A or B
(403)Eccentric element on crankshaft
IV-M-98
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism IV Hydraulic System
2. Hydraulic drive
This chapter describes the hydraulic motor, brake valve, parking brake and the hydraulic motor’s two-speed
select mechanism, which are all used in the hydraulic drive.
1) Functions
1-1 Hydraulic motor
The hydraulic motor is of swash-plate axial piston type. The force of pressure oil coming from the pump
is converted to rotational movement.
1-2 Brake valve
(1) Inertial force is controlled in stopping the hydraulic motor. This helps bring the motor to a smooth halt.
(2) When the hydraulic motor is activated by an external force, this valve keeps the motor from running
out of control. In other words, hydraulic cavitation can be avoided.
(3) The valve also keeps off an excessive pressure that would occur in case of a sudden hydraulic motor
halt.
1-3 Relief valve
(1) The hydraulic motor gives out some jerk when it gets started and stopped. This valve is intended to
ease such shock as well as to avoid cavitation due to the relief action (lower braking noise).
(2) The relief valve suppresses a sudden pressure upon the hydraulic motor below its preset pressure
level. In this way, the hydraulic motor is protected against damages.
1-4 Two-speed select mechanism
The mechanism is designed to select the hydraulic motor output in two stages: high-speed, low-torque
output, and low-speed, high-torque output.
1-5 Parking brake
The parking brake keeps the at-rest hydraulic motor from starting by an external force. This friction disc
type brake is integrated with the hydraulic motor.
(102) Shaft
(103) Swash-plate
(104) Cylinder block
(105) Piston
(109) Timing plate
IV-M-99
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism IV Hydraulic System
1. Steady running
When the pressure oil flows from the pump to the port A,
the hydraulic motor gets started. Here are the details.
The pressure oil from the pump flows first through the
port A, which opens the valve (327). Passing through
this valve, the oil flows then through the port C into the
(405) hydraulic motor, which is given a rotational force.
The pressure oil through the port A also flows through
(323) the small opening of spool (323) and the passage a
into the chamber b . By the hydraulic force in the cham-
ber b , the spool (323) slides from the neutral position
(404) to the left. The groove in the spool (323) forms a pas-
sage for the oil to flow between the ports D and B.
The hydraulic oil out of the hydraulic motor flows
through the port D first and then B. In this way, the
hydraulic motor starts running and the hydraulic oil
returns into the oil tank.
When the spool (323) slides to the left, on the other
hand, the pressure oil flows through the port E. From
here, the oil goes to the parking brake and the two-
speed selector valve.
(323)Spool
(327)Valve
(404)Spring
(405)Parking brake
(327)
IV-M-100
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism IV Hydraulic System
2. Stopping (braking)
When the pressure oil is interrupted, the hydraulic motor
gets stopped. Here are the details.
When the pressure oil to the port A is blocked, the pres-
sure at the port A and in the chamber b drops. Accord-
ingly the spool (323) starts sliding from left to the neutral
position by the force of spring (328). Then the oil in the
chamber b is expected to flow through the passage a
of spool (323) toward the port A. The throttling effect of
passage a , however, produces a back pressure and
controls the return speed of spool (323).
(323) The hydraulic motor, even after the block of the pressure
oil at port A, is expected to keep running by its inertial
force. The hydraulic oil from the hydraulic motor is thus
expected to pass through the port D, the spool’s groove,
(328) the rear flange (301) back to the port B.
When the spool (323) has returned exactly to the neutral
position, the return passage of the hydraulic motor is
completely blocked and the hydraulic motor stops itself.
In doing so, the brake valve narrows down the return
passage of the hydraulic motor under the sliding speed
(327) control of spool (323) as well as by the spool groove’s
shape. The resulting back pressure brings the hydraulic
(323)Spool motor, still under its inertial force, to a smooth halt.
(327)Valve The valve (327) gets activated by a very small negative
(328)Spring pressure. The oil passage between the circuit of port A
and the motor’s suction port C gets open, which pre-
vents cavitation in the hydraulic motor.
(323)Spool
(327)Valve
(328)Spring
(405)Parking brake
(328)
IV-M-101
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism IV Hydraulic System
(406)
(407)
(411)
(412)
(408)
(409)
(413)
(410)
(414) (415)
(406)Orifice f
Pressure oil flow from port A (407)Valve e
(408)Orifice g
(409)Chamber y
(410)Piston h
(411)Piston d
(412)Orifice c
(413)Orifice b
(414)Valve a
(415)Chamber x
IV-M-102
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism IV Hydraulic System
Pressure
Time
R/V B open
Let s suppose, however, that the piston h is already at its stroke end depending on how the machine
stopped immediately before. In such case, the valve e of relief valve B does not open. The pressure
at the port C is thus as shown in the chart below.
Pressure
Time
As discussed above, the startup pressure at the port C depends on the position of piston h .
When the pressure oil from the pump flows from the port B to D, the relief valves A and B
exchange their behaviors according to the above principle.
IV-M-103
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism IV Hydraulic System
2. Stopping
The hydraulic motor runs by the supply of pressure oil from the port A to C. When no pressure oil comes
from the port A, the counterbalance valve returns to the neutral position.
With the counterbalance valve in neutral, the outlet port D is blocked and the hydraulic motor keeps run-
ning by its inertial force alone. This applies a pressure at the port D. At the relief valve A , the pressure
oil out of the port D flows through the orifices b and c in the valve a into the chamber x . The pres-
sure oil in the chamber x then moves the piston d to its stroke end. During this shift, the pressure in
the chamber x does not rise. So the valve a of relief valve A is pushed open by the pressure oil at
port D. The pressure oil at port D then flows toward the low-pressure port C.
When the relief valve A is activated, the pressure at port D is controlled and the oil is supplied to the
port C, which prevents cavitation.
When the piston d has reached its stroke end, the pressure in the chamber x and that between the
orifices b and c rise, getting the valve a closed. If the shovel’s system pressure is exceeded in this
case, the relief valve A gets activated to stop the hydraulic motor.
On the other hand, the piston h of relief valve B moves in the direction of arrow by the pressure oil at
port D. The oil in the chamber y goes through the orifices g and f into the port C.
(406) (407)
(411)
(408) (412)
(406)Orifice f
(409) (407)Valve e
(413) (408)Orifice g
(410)
(409)Chamber y
(410)Piston h
(411)Piston d
(412)Orifice c
(413)Orifice b
(414) (415) (414)Valve a
(415)Chamber x
Pressure oil flow blocked from port A
IV-M-104
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism IV Hydraulic System
Pressure at the hydraulic motor (port D) with the pressure oil flow blocked
Pressure
Time
Piston d shifted
R/V A open
The pressure with the piston d being shifted is commonly called the primary relief pressure (low).
The pressure with the piston d already shifted is commonly called the secondary relief pressure (high).
IV-M-105
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism IV Hydraulic System
(422)
(161)
(423)
(425)
(424)
(103)Swash plate
(161)Piston
(371)Spool
(381)Spring
(421)Spindle
(422)Chamber S
(423)Support
(424)Face X
(425)Motor case
IV-M-106
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism IV Hydraulic System
2. High-speed stage
At the high-speed stage, the pilot pressure of over 1.96 MPs (20 kgf/cm2) is supplied from the port P. In
such state, the spool (371) surpasses the force of spring (381) and is pushed to the right. The pressure
oil at port F is then introduced through the spool (371) into the chamber S.
The pressure oil in the chamber S makes the thrust of piston (161) high. The piston (161) pushes up the
swash-plate (103) until it comes into contact with the face X. The swash-plate (103) stays in this position
at the maximum tilt angle of T2.
In other words, the hydraulic motor comes to its minimum cylinder capacity and runs at the high speed.
(422)
(161)
(423)
(425)
(424)
(103)Swash plate
(161)Piston
(371)Spool
(381)Spring
(421)Spindle
(422)Chamber S
(423)Support
(424)Face X
(425)Motor case
IV-M-107
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism IV Hydraulic System
2. Braking
The pressure oil is not supplied to the port A or B.
(112) (104) (116) (115) The spool (323) of brake valve shifts to the neutral
position, which closes the port E. Now the pres-
sure in the cylinder c drops. When this pressure
has dropped below 0.47 MPs (4.8 kgf/cm2), the
hydraulic pressure of piston (112) becomes less
than the force of spring (113). The force of spring
(113) activates the piston (112) to press the mat-
ing plate (116) and friction plate (115) together.
This pressing force turns in the friction force for
braking.
The friction plate (115) is also engaged with the
cylinder block (104) of hydraulic motor. The cylin-
der block (104) is equally coupled with the shaft
(102) of hydraulic motor.
(113) In this way, the hydraulic motor is given a braking
torque.
(104)Cylinder block
(112)Piston
(113)Spring
(115)Friction plate
(116)Mating plate
IV-M-108
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism IV Hydraulic System
H.Cylinder
a. Shockless valve of Boom cylinder pilot line
(1) Structure
(1) Plunger
(2) Ring
(3) Spring
(4) Body
(5) Spool
(6) Spring
(8) Orifice
(9) Retainer
(11) Collared plug
(12) Collared plug Fig. 1.
(14) Steel ball
(15) O ring
(16) O ring
IV-M-109
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism IV Hydraulic System
(2) Function
(Let s discuss the ports A and 1 here. The same is true of the ports B and 2.)
FS = FA x FB (FA = P1 x a P2 x b = FB)
Where, FS: Force of spring (3)
FA: Downward force upon plunger (1)
FB: Upward force upon plunger (1)
P1: Pressure in chamber (i)
P2: Pressure in chamber (ii)
a, b: Pressure receiving area on plunger (1) (a = b)
(ii)
Fig. 2.
IV-M-110
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism IV Hydraulic System
IV-M-111
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism IV Hydraulic System
b. Specifications
Maximum operating pressure 31.4 MPa, 320 kgf/cm2 4551 psi
Maximum allowable flow rate (P-port) A o B 150 L/min, 39.63 GPM
Cracking pressure B-port pressurized PB = 30.4 0.5 MPa, 310 5 kgf/cm2, 4409 71 psi
A-port pressurized PA = 0.2 MPa, 2 kgf/cm2 28 psi
PL-port pressurized PPL= 0.5 +0.05
-0.10 MPa, 5 -+0.5 2 +7.0
1.0 kgf/cm 71 -14.2 psi
Leakage Holding valve internal 0.8 cc/min at B port, 8.3MPa (85 kgf/cm2 )
Hydraulic oil used Mineral hydraulic oil ISO VG3 or VG46 or equivalent
Allowable hydraulic oil contamination Below Class NAS10
Operating temperature range -20 +95°C
c. Circuit diagram
IV-M-112
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism IV Hydraulic System
(2) (6)
(6)
(7)
IV-M-113
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism IV Hydraulic System
f. Circuit function
1. Newtral position
When the spool stays neutral (with no pilot pressure applied), the poppet seat (a), spool seat (b), sliding
spool seal (c) and relief valve poppet seat (d) all serve to stop a leak from the cylinder. In this way, the cylin-
der is prevented against gravity fall.
(3)-1
(3)-2
(1)
B port
(c)
(d)
(4)
(b)
(2)
IV-M-115
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism IV Hydraulic System
2. With oil flowing from A-port to B-port (from main control valve to cylinder)
The oil from A-port flows against the cylinder pressure and the poppet s return spring force. It then gets the
poppet open and flows on to B-port.
B port
A port
IV-M-116
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism IV Hydraulic System
(2) Because of the pilot pressure, the pistons (3)-1 and (3)-2 as well as the spool are activated against the
spool s return spring force. The return oil from the actuator flows from B-port (cylinder) through the spool
control (h) into A-port (main control valve).
(e)
(f)
(3)-1
(g)
B port
(3)-2
(h)
A port
IV-M-117
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism IV Hydraulic System
(3) When the pilot pressure rises higher, the poppet spring chamber (i) gets connected to the A-port side
with the spool internal passage in between. The poppet s orifice (j) then causes a pressure difference
between B-port and poppet spring chamber, which gets the poppet open.
(e)
(i)
(j) (l)
B port
(h)
(m)
A port
(e) Pilot chamber
(h) Control
(i) Poppet spring chamber
(e) Pilot chamber
Fig. 4 With oil flowing from B-pot to A-port (at high pilot pressure) (i) Poppet spring chamber
(j) Orifice
(l)From boom cylinder bottom
(m) To main control valve
IV-M-118
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism IV Hydraulic System
(1)
(2)
(3)
B port
A port
(h) Control
(k) Pilot chamber
Fig. 5
(1) Piston 1
(2) Piston 2
(3) Spool
IV-M-119
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism IV Hydraulic System
B port
A port
IV-M-120
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism IV Hydraulic System
J. Solenoid valve
a. Solenoid proportional control valve
Hydraulic symbol
ontrol iagram
IV-M-121
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism IV Hydraulic System
(1)
(2)
(3)
(1) Type of connection : equivalent to amp econoseal J senies connectors mark II (+) gap hausing
(Gap housing : 174354 -2, Terminal : 173706 - 1)
(2) Tightening torque : 7 1 N m
(3) 2 - M8 screw depth 12 : Tightening torque
IV-M-122
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism IV Hydraulic System
601
171
101
IV-M-123
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
I Hydraulic system
A.Troubleshooting I -S-3
a.Case - Study : Abnormal speed I
-S-4
b.Case - Study : The power is weak I
-S-5
c.Case - Study : Poor Manipulation and Abnormal Operation I
-S-6
d.LS control system troubleshooting I
-S-9
e.Pump component trouble causes and remedy I -S-14
f. Control valve component troubleshootin I -S-16
g.Travel motor component troubleshooting I -S-18
B.Specifications I -S-21
a.Specification of pump I -S-21
b.Relief Valve pressur setting I -S-22
c.Swivel perfoemance I -S-26
d.Traveling performance I -S-27
e.Cylinder I -S-29
C.Testing I -S-35
a.Testing Instruments special tools I -S-35
b.Precautions in handling the pump I -S-37
c.Pilot pressure I -S-39
d.Main relief valve : LS system I -S-41
e.Main relief valve : Travel system I -S-42
f. Unload valve I -S-43
g.Overload relief valve I -S-44
h.Swivel brake valve pressure I -S-46
i.Measuring the main pump Max. flow rate I -S-48
j.Measuring the main pump’s stand-by flow rate I -S-50
k.LS control pressur I -S-51
l.Traveling motor drain amount I -S-52
m.Swivel motor drain amount I -S-53
n.Swivel motor block performance I -S-54
o.Traveling motor block performance I -S-55
p.Operating speed I -S-56
I -1
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
I -2
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
A.Troubleshooting
a. Case - Study : Abnormal speed
Fig.1 Main relief valve
Problems Probable causes Remedies Ref.Fig.
1 The speed of all 1) The engine rpm is low. 1) Adjust the accelerator cable or link. Sleeve "E"
actuators is low. 2) Check the engine systems (fuel system, compression system).
2) The quantity of working fluid in the hydraulic oil tank is too 1) Replenish or replace the working fluid. Pilot poppet
small. The oil quality is poor.
3) The suction line (suction filter) is clogged. 1) Check the suction line. Replace the suction filter.
4) The control differential pressure of the LS regulator is too low. 1) Actually measure the front unit or the swivel speed and make an Fig.15
The locknut of the differential pressure control spring in the LS adjustment so as to bring the setting of the spring within specifications.
regulator is loosened or maladjusted. In the figure, tightening the setscrew increases the actuator speed and
(If the speed of all actuators is too high, suspect that the control loosening the setscrew decreases the speed.
differential pressure is too high.)
5) Gear pump volumetric efficiency is too low, so that LS control 1) Check gear pump delivery pressure and volumetric efficiency. Renew
pressure difference is not enough. gear pump.
Chamber "D"
6) Leak from the PLS signal circuit (abnormal conditions of the 1) Check the hose connections for leak. Disassemble and check the
PLS signal circuit in the control valve) PLS signal circuit in the control valve. Main poppet
7) Insufficient pressure due to defects in the unload valve seat 1) Measure the unload pressure. Disassemble and clean the unload Fig.2
valve seat.
8) Insufficient pressure due to defects in the main relief valve 1) Measure and readjust the main relief pressure. Disassemble and Fig.1 Fig. 2 Unload valve
seat clean the relief valve seat.
9) Shut-off valve of inlet section is loosened, so that main pump 1) Check shut-off valve and retighten.
pressure got down to tank.
LS main
LS relief valve
10) Defects or wear in the pump-mounting coupling 1) Repair or replace the pump coupling. sensing
11) Breakage or wear in the pump drive shaft 1) Replace the shaft.
12) Seizure, breakage or wear in the pump internal parts 1) Repair or replace the pump.
2 The speed of all 1) The pilot filter is clogged. 1) Clean the pilot filter. Replace the filter if necessary. Fig.6 Pp3
the actuators in 2) Dust caught in the changeover valve or wear has caused the 1) Disassemble and clean the changeover valve and adjust the pilot Fig.7
the hydraulic pilot primary pressure to drop. relief pressure.
pilot system is
too low. 3) Pilot primary relief valve is misadjusted. 1) Check the pressure and readjust it with shim.
4) Insufficient discharge quantity of the pilot pump 1) Test the pilot pump performance. Replace the pump if it is defective.
Unload valve
3 All the speeds 1) The screen built in the pilot valve on the R or L side is 1) Disassemble and clean the screen.
on the R or L clogged.
side in the pilot 2) The pilot primary line on the R or L side is defective or the pilot 1) Check the defective pilot valve primary line. Replace the pilot valve Fig.8, 9
manipulation valve is defective. assembly if necessary.
system are too Unload valve and LS main relief valve
Arm regeneration orifice
low or the
manipulation is
poor. Fig. 3 Overload relief valve
4 The speed of a 1) The control spool has got stuck in the neutral position. 1) Disassemble and service the pilot valve. Eliminate the cause of the Fig.10
certain hydraulic stick. Replace the assembly if necessary.
pilot section is 2) The relevant spool of the pilot valve has got stuck. 1) Measure the pilot secondary pressure. Adjust the pressure using a Fig.8, 9
too low. (In both the A and B ports, a stick is rare.) shim.
3) The pilot secondary pressure is too low. 1) Check the pilot spool for abnormal wear. Replace the valve assembly
if necessary.
IV-S-3
Spool
IV-S-4
Push rod
Main spool
Spring seat
Pressure High pressure
compensation selection valve
spool
Spool
IV-S-5
3) The control spool of the horsepower control valve has got stuck. 3) If the horsepower control valve is set improperly,
reset it.
4) The horsepower control valve is set improperly. For the resetting of the horsepower control valve, Fig.14
refer to the P-Q characteristic diagram.
2 The response of the work 1) The orifice in the pump is clogged with dirt. 1) Disassemble and clean.
machine is abnormally 2) The unload valve orifice is clogged with dirt. 1) Disassemble and clean.
slow. (Especially, at low 3) The PLS line orifice is clogged with dirt. 1) Disassemble and clean.
temperatures)
3 An abnormal sound is 1) Air bleeding hose is kept open. 1) Bleed the air from the pump and plug the hose. Main spool
heard from the pump. 2) The quantity of working fluid is smaller than the required quantity. 1) Check the quantity of working fluid and replenish.
Pressure
3) The working fluid viscosity is improper. 1) Use the recommended working fluid. compensation
High pressure
selection valve
4) Air is sucked through the suction hose or pipes. 1) Check and retighten the hose and pipe. Bleed spool
them.
5) There are contaminants or pieces of metal. 1) Overhaul and clean the pump. Replace the pump
assembly if necessary. Load check Backet(Boom) section
4 Loud noise is heard from 1) The delivery hose touches something and rattles. 1) Reinstall the hose. Prevent the hose from touch-
around the control unit. ing.
2) The relief valve makes squeaking noises. 1) Check the relief pressure. Disassemble and clean
the relief valve. Replace the relief valve assembly if
necessary.
5 The boom is not raised There is a possibility that the arm compensation spool has got stuck on the open 1) Eliminate the cause of a compensation spool stick Fig.11
when horizontal work is side. completely.
done through simulta- (Principle) 2) Replace the arm section assembly of the control
neous manipulation of the When the boom is manipulated, the arm compensation spool works in the direction valve.
boom and the arm at idle where it is closed, since the operating pressure for raising the boom is high. How-
or low rpm. ever, the pressure compensation is not made due to a stick and the pump flow is
directed to the arm crowd side under light load. As a result, the pressure for raising
the boom is not built up.
6 The spontaneous boom 1) Failure of the seal in the cylinder 1) Replace the seal.
fall amount is large. 2) Failure of the boom overload relief valve 1) Disassemble and clean the relief valve.
3) Failure of the load check valve 1) Check the load check valve.
4) Failure of the holding valve seat 1) Disassemble and clean the fall prevention valve.
7 The swivel does not stop. The makeup poppet has got stuck. It is clogged with dirt. Disassemble and clean the poppet.
The swivel main spool has got stuck. Disassemble and clean the control valve swivel por-
tion.
The relief valve of the swivel motor is clogged with dirt. Disassemble and clean the relief valve.
IV-S-6
IV-S-7
Pilot filter
Compensation spool
Unload valve
3) Pump LS regurator
Control pin
4)Actuators Cylinders
Swivel motor
IV-S-9
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
Basically, the control valve consists of the following parts. Trouble phenomena occur as shown below.
It is preferable that the following steps be performed to determine the cause of trouble.
1) Unload valve
Make a check if the unload pressure is not built up at the maximum rpm under no load with the valve
placed in the neutral position.
KX080-3: Max. engine KPM=27 kgf/cm2 (2.65 MPa, 384 psi)
Idle RPM=23 kgf/cm2, 2.25 MPa, 327 psi
(Check the pump discharge quantity.)
2) Main relief valve
Make a check if the main relief pressure is not built up.
KX080-3: 285 kgf/cm2, 27.9 MPa, 4047 psi
If any one actuator is relieved, the main relief pressure is built up.
(For the dozer UP only, however, there is a 135 k overload relief valve.)
3) Spool in the valve section
1. The spool must work at a full stroke under the secondary pressure of the pilot valve.
2. If the spool does not work at a full stroke even when the secondary pressure is the specified pres-
sure, suspect that the spool has got stuck.
3. If the cylinder speed does not increase even when the spool works at a full stroke, suspect that the
spool is misassembled.
4) High pressure selector valve
1. If the high pressure selector valve does not move normally due to a stick, its own high pressure
leaks from the valve, causing the PLS pressure to the compensation spool and the PLS pressure
to the LS regulator to decrease, respectively. As a result, tilting takes place so as to reduce the
pump discharge quantity, so that the actuator speed decreases.
2. Similar phenomena occur in the sections downstream from the section of the defective high pres-
sure selector valve.
3. The sections upstream from the section of the defective high pressure selector valve work nor-
mally.
4. If the section of the defective high pressure selector valve and the sections upstream from it are
manipulated at the same time, the PLS pressure to the pump acts on the upstream sections and
the pump is normally LS-controlled.
5. If the high pressure selector valve gets stuck, the same phenomena occur in both the A and B
ports.
IV-S-10
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
5) Compensation spool
1. The compensation spool moves based on a balance between the PC pressure and the load pres-
sure. However, the symptom depends on the position in which a stick occurs.
2. If a stick occurs in the stroke-0 position, i.e. in a state of the so-called under lap, the cylinder speed
decreases, since the opening in the spool is small. The speed is almost the same as that obtained
when other sections are relieved and manipulated simultaneously.
(The simultaneous manipulation must be in the horsepower control area.)
3. If the compensation spool gets stuck in the full open position during the simultaneous manipulation
under light and heavy loads, the pump flow is apt to be directed to the light load side when the
compensation spool on the light load side gets stuck in the full open position, making it difficult to
control the heavy load side.
4. If a stick occurs in the intermediate stroke position, it is difficult to control the heavy load side up to
the stick position of the compensation spool.
In the operation conditions beyond the stick position, the cylinder speed is lower than normal.
5. What will happen if the compensation spool is misassembled?
In a state of the under lap, compare the cylinder speed with a normal machine.
The cylinder speed decreases with decreasing under lap opening area.
6. If the compensation spool gets stuck as shown above, disassemble and clean the spool. Elimi-
nate the cause of trouble completely and reassemble the spool. Replace parts if necessary. In
some cases, replace the section assembly.
IV-S-11
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
Therefore, the pump failure symptoms are broadly classified into the following two types.
1. The speed of the work machine is low, since the required flow is not discharged from the pump.
o Failure of LS control
2 The engine stalls in certain conditions. o Failure of horsepower control
These problems are basically attributed to the failure of pump swash plate control. The provable
causes of this failure are malfunctions such as a stick of each control portion due to contamination.
The fundamentals of LS pump troubleshooting are shown on the next page using the figure below.
LS control
(1)Pps = PLS + PF + Pp P3 Pav Pmax Pc
Pps
Pmax
Pc
Ppa
Pp
Ppb
PLS
LS-control valve
IV-S-12
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
IV-S-13
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
1. Checking of filter
Check the filter element periodically. Check whether or not abnormal impurities are generated in large
amount. The cause of trouble may be predicted depending on the type of impurity.
2. Checking of drain oil
Check drain oil coming from the pump, motor etc. The cause of trouble can be predicted from drain
flowrate and type of impurity contained in drain oil.
3. Checking for abnormal noise and vibration.
Check various equipment for any abnormal noise and vibration.
Discovery of the source of abnormal noise and vibration leads to the clue of clarification of cause of
trouble.
4. Checking of pressure at various parts
Do not disassemble and check irrelevant equipment unnecessarily, but check the pressure by means
of pressure gauge and investigate the cause of trouble.
IV-S-14
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
IV-S-15
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
IV-S-16
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
IV-S-17
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
IV-S-18
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
IV-S-19
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
IV-S-20
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
B.Specifications
a.Specifications of pump
Unit KX080-3 Remarks
Manufacturer KYB Co.,Ltd.
Model PSVL2-36C-4
Kubota part No. RD809-6111-0
Rated pump rpm rpm 2000
Main relief MPa 29.4
pressure kgf/cm2 300
a1/a2 psi 4267
MPa 20.6
Rated load pressure Main relief kgf/cm2 210
pressure a4 psi 2987
MPa 3.92
Pilot primary
kgf/cm2 40
pressure a6
psi 569
Main pump cc/rev 36.0/36.0 Sprit flow of variable displacement
P1/P2 cu.in./rev 2.20/2.20 piston pump
Theoretical Main pump cc/rev 33.0
Gear pump
discharge capacity P3 cu.in./rev 2.01
cc/rev 8.1
Pilot pump Pp Gear pump
cu.in./rev 0.49
Main pump L/min 72.0/72.0
P1/P2 USGPM 19.02/19.02
Theoretical Main pump L/min 67.0
discharge capacity P3 USGPM 17.70
L/min 16.0
Pilot pump Pp
USGPM 4.23
MPa 1.5
LS control Engine rpm propotional control with
Differential pressure kgf/cm2 15.3
valve P4, Idling /Rated = about 60 - 70%
psi 218
L/min 22.0
Standby flow rate
USGPM 5.81
PC horsepower control valve : With P3 horsepower shift
Swash plate control aided by self-tilting moment(Small piston
Horsepower control
deleted.)
P1 + P2 pressure : Average pressure by orifice
Bearing : Cradle
Structure Shoe plate : Spherical
Large-diameter piston (with shoe)
IV-S-21
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
(2) Main relief valve (at the measurement port on the machine)
No. Valve location Operating work Unit KX080-3 Remarks
+1.0
MPa 30.4
-1.0
+10
1 Travel main relief valve a1 kgf/cm2 310
-10
+145
psi 4409
-145
+1.0
MPa 30.4
-1.0
+10
2 Travel main relief valve a2 kgf/cm2 310
-10
+145
psi 4409
-145
+1.0
MPa 21.6
-1.0
+10
3 Main relief valve a4 kgf/cm2 220
-10
+145
psi 3133
-145
+0.5
MPa 2.65
-0.5
+5
4 LS unload relief valve b6 kgf/cm2 27 Idle:23 k
-5
+73
psi 384
-73
+1.0
MPa 27.9
-1.0
+10
5 LS main relief a3 LS regurator kgf/cm2 285
-10
+145
psi 4047
-145
IV-S-22
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
IV-S-23
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
(4) verload relief valve (at the measurement port on the machine
No. valve location Operating work Unit KX080-3 Remarks
+1.0
6 MPa 31.5
Boom up/down -1.0
Bucket +10
7 Control valve
dump/crowd kgf/cm2 321 at 1500 rpm
-10
Arm dump +145
8 psi 4569
-145
+1.0
MPa 30.5
-1.0
+10
9 Control valve Arm crowd kgf/cm2 311 at 1500 rpm
-10
+145
psi 4424
-145
+1.0
MPa 22.1
-1.0
Auxiliary port 1 +10
10 Control valve
delivery/return kgf/cm2 225 at 1500 rpm
-10
+145
psi 3205
-145
+1.0
MPa 27.4
-1.0
+10
11 Control valve Blade down kgf/cm2 279 at 1500 rpm
-10
+145
psi 3974
-145
+1.0
MPa 13.2
-1.0
+10
12 Control valve Blade up kgf/cm2 135 at 1500 rpm
-10
+145
psi 1915
-145
+1.0
MPa 21.6
-1.0
+10
13 Swivel motor Swivel, R&L kgf/cm2 220 at 1500 rpm
-10
+145
psi 3133
-145
+1.0
MPa 35.0
-1.0
+10
14 Travel motor Travel, R&L kgf/cm2 357 at 1500 rpm
-10
+145
psi 5076
-145
Note
1.Main relief valae adjusting angle : 60 kgf/cm2 per 90degrees.
2.As for a1 relief valve, several hoses are required to disconnect for adjusting this main relief valve.
IV-S-24
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
IV-S-25
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
c.Swivel performance
Unit KX080-3 Remarks
Manufacturer Kubota Seiki
Model RD118-6170-0
Kubota part No. RD118-6170-0
cc/rev 44.1
Motor Displacement
cu.in/rev 2.69
Reduction ratio 20.615
cc/rev 909
Total Displacement
cu.in/rev 55.48
L/min 66
Max.oil flow Rated flow rate
USGPM 17.44
Motor speed rpm 72.6 KX080-3: at 66 L/min (17.44 USGPM)
MPa 21.6
Relief valve pressure
(at bench) kgf/cm2 220 KX080-3: at 66 L/min (17.44 USGPM)
psi 3129
N.m 950
Theoretical output torque kgf.m 96.9 KX080-3 : at 21.6MPa(220kgf/cm2, 3129psi)
ft.lbs 701
L/min 4.00
Drain amount at lock New machine
cu.in/min 1.06
L/min 0.50
Drain amount while roating New machine
cu.in/min 0.13
MPa 0.3
Max. drain pressure kgf/cm2 3
psi 43
pinion / swivel teeth
Swivel speed rpm 9.5
KX080-3 : 13/100
3 times rotation swivel time sec. 18.9
Swivel block performance at
deg. 0
engine stop
Swivel block performance at
deg. 0 Bucket empty
engine running
Capable swivel rotation angle deg. 17 Bucket crowded,Arm extended
mm
Play at the tip of bucket Reference value
in.
MPa 1.5
Brake release pressure 2 15
kgf/cm
psi 213
IV-S-26
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
d.Traveling performance
Unit KX080-3 Remarks
Manufacturer Nabtesco Corp.
Model GM09VN-B-21/36-3
Kubota part No. RD809-6129-0
cc/rev 21.3
1st
cu.in./rev 1.30
Capacity
cc/rev 36.3
2nd
cu.in./rev 2.22
Reduction ratio 1/61.6
cc/rev 1312.1
1st
cu.in./rev 80.07
Total displacement
cc/rev 2236.1
2nd
cu.in./rev 136.46
L/min 72
Rated oil flow
USGPM 19.02
N.m 9000
1st kgf.m 917.7
ft.lbf 6637.9 KX080-3: at 24.5MPa
Theoretical torque
N.m 5160 (300kgf/cm2, 4267 psi)
2nd kgf.m 526.2
ft.lbf 3805.8
1F 31.6
Theoretical speed rpm KX080-3 : at 72 L/min (19.02 USGPM)
2F 52.7
MPa 29.4
Relief valve pressure kgf/cm2 300
psi 4267
Climbing ability deg. 30
kN 55.2
Slip 70% theoretical torque
1F kgf 5633 Oil temp.:50±5°C(122±9°F)
lbf 12420.8
Max. traction force
kN 34.3
2F kgf 3500 Relief 60% theoretical torque
lbf 7717.5
mm/10min 0,300 10 min engine stop
Traveling block performance
in./10min Testing slope angle: 20 deg.
0.00,11.81
km/h 3.1
1st
Traveling speed mph 1.93
(Rubber/Steel) km/h 4.6
2nd
mph 2.86
10m(32.8ft) 1F sec./10m
traveling time
2F (32.8ft)
(Rubber crawler)
IV-S-27
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
IV-S-28
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
e.Cylinder
(1) Speed
KX080-3
Unit Remarks
(A) (B)
Canopy sec. - GL to Max. height
Up
Cabin sec. 3.1 to 3.7 4.4 (exclude cushion time)
Boom cylinder Canopy sec. -
Down Max. height to GL
Cabin sec. 3.1 to 3.7 4.4
cushion sec. 0.4 to 1.3 1.6
Crowd sec. 3.4 to 4.0 4.8
Arm cylinder Cylinder full stroke
Dump sec. 3.2 to 3.8 4.6
Crowd sec. 3.2 to 3.8 4.6
Bucket cylinder Cylinder full stroke
Dump sec. 1.9 to 2.5 3.0
Canopy sec. -
Left
Cabin sec. 6.6 to 7.2 8.6
Swing cylinder Cylinder full stroke
Canopy sec. -
Right
Cabin sec. 7.8 to 8.4 10.1
Up sec. 1.9 to 2.5 3.0
Blade cylinder Cylinder full stroke
Down sec. 2.6 to 3.2 3.8
(A) New machine reference value
(B) Allowable limi
IV-S-29
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
IV-S-30
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
2)Cylinder dimensions
IV-S-31
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
KX080-3
Unit A B C D E F G H J Port screw size Remarks
mm 70 70 90 90 65 115 134 57 70
Boom G 1/2" KYB Co.,Ltd.
in. 2.76 2.76 3.54 3.54 2.56 4.53 5.28 2.24 2.76
mm 60 60 85 85 60 100 118 55 58
Arm G 1/2" KYB Co.,Ltd.
in. 2.36 2.36 3.35 3.35 2.36 3.94 4.65 2.17 2.28
mm 60 60 75 75 55 90 112 60 55
Bucket G 1/2" KYB Co.,Ltd.
in. 2.36 2.36 2.95 2.95 2.17 3.54 4.41 2.36 2.17
mm 70 70 80 80 60 110 131 65 58 Koretsune
Swing G 1/2"
in. 2.76 2.76 3.15 3.15 2.36 4.33 5.16 2.56 2.28 Seiko Ltd.
IV-S-32
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
3)Tightening torque
(1) Boom cylinder
Tightening torque Thread size
Unit Adhesive
KX080-3 KX080-3
N·m 350-400
Cylinder head kgf·m 35.7-40.8
ft·lbs 258.1-295.0
N·m 600±120
Piston kgf·m 61.2±12.2
ft·lbs 442.5±88.5
N·m 20
Set screw kg·m 2.0 M8x1.25
ft·lbs 14.8
IV-S-33
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
IV-S-34
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
C.Testing
a. Testing Instruments & special tools
(1) Gauges and special tools for pressure testing
1. Pressure hose
2. Pressure gauge; 2.94 MPa, 30kgf/cm2, 427 psi
For Secondary pilot pressure test.
3. Pressure gauge; 5.88 MPa, 60kgf/cm2, 853psi
For primary pilot pressure test.
4. Pressure gauge; 39.2 MPa, 400kgf/cm2,
5689psi
For main relief pressure and overload relief
pressure test.
5. Pipe joint (S, F2 - F2)
code No.: 69181-63191
6. Pressure test plug; PT 1/8
7. Allen wrench; M5
8. Plug; PT 1/8 Code No.: 68311-13381
9. Wrench; Size 17 - 19 mm
IV-S-35
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
Vacuum pump
FESTO VAD-1/4 9334
P R
IV-S-36
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
Note:
Be careful never to raise the engine rpm without the
hex plug in place. Air may sucked in, getting the
pump damaged.
IV-S-37
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
(2) Air bleeding method in case the hydraulic oil in the tank looks cloudy with air bub-
bled
(Without taking the following steps, unusual noise may heard and what’s worse, the pump may get
damaged.)
Note:
Be sure to run the engine at the idling speed. If
higher than this, air is sucked into the bleeder hose.
IV-S-38
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
c. Pilot pressure
(1) Primary pressure
CAUTION
Relieve the pilot line pressure bofore removing the
pressure port.
Otherwise, oil will splash out by accumulated pres-
sure.
IV-S-39
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
IV-S-40
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
1) LS unload valve
2) LS main relief valve
3) 4) Travel main relief valve
IV-S-41
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
1) LS unload valve
2) LS main relief valve
3) 4) Travel main relief valve
3) 2) 1)
IV-S-42
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
f. Unload valve
(Measurement method)
1) 3) 1. Set the pressure gauge to the coupler at the main
pump discharge side. Or remove the plug off the
main pump discharge side and set the pressure
gauge there.
2. Start the engine and run it at the maximun speed.
3. Measure the unload valve pressure. At this mea-
2) surement, all control levers should be at neutral
position.
4. Take 2 or 3 measurements to have their respec-
tion exact readings.
5. Hydraulic oil and temperature are as follows.
oil :ISO VG46
4) Temp. :50 ± 5 °C, 122 ± 9°F
• Adjustment
4)
If the measured pressure is lower than specifica-
tion, screw in the set screw.
And vice-versa.
1) LS unload valve
2) LS main relief valve
3) 4) Travel main relief valve
3) 2) 1)
IV-S-43
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
IV-S-44
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
6)
8)
7)
10)
9)
12) 11)
14) 13)
1)
(B)
2)
3)
4)
5)
16)
15)
IV-S-45
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
5)
6)
7)
5)
IV-S-46
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
IV-S-47
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
IV-S-48
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
[Measurement]
1. Raise the engine speed to the maximum rpm.
2. Gradurally close the flowmeter’s loading valve
and measure the flowrate and engine rpm at
each pressure point in the P-Q curve.
3. Take the measurements 3 times.
Determin the averages and take them as the final
ones.
* Keep the oil temperature at 50 ± 5 °C(122 ± 9°F)
for the measurements.
Joint B
Joint A
(1)Pump
(2)Control valve
(3)Line filter
(4)Tester
X Plug
IV-S-49
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
IV-S-50
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
k. LS control pressure
The actual measurement of LS control differential pressure requires special equipment such as a dif-
ferential pressure instrument. General maintenance shops do not have such a expertise measuring
device. This section introduces a simple method that makes use of the swivel motion or travel opera-
tion. of an actual machine.
1. Place the machine on hard ground.
2. Warm up the machine to the oil temp. of 50 ± 5 °C
(122 ± 9 °F).
3. Raise up the engine speed at Max. rpm.
4. Measure the time for three turns constant swivel
function
1)
Reference value : See Specifications
5. Adjustment
1) If actual measurement speed is slower than
2)
specification, loosen the lock nut and screw in
the set screw.
2) If actual measurement speed is faster than
specification, loosen the lock nut and screw
back the set screw.
Note:Before loosening the nut, put alignment mark
on body, lock nut and set screw.
1) LS control valve
2) Set screw
IV-S-51
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
IV-S-52
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
IV-S-53
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
IV-S-54
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
IV-S-55
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
p. Operating speed
(1) Checking each operating speed.
[Important points]
1. Measure full stroke operating time with no load on the standard bucket.
2. Make several mesurement and use average time for judgement.
3. Two different measurements are expected for the forward and backward movements as well as
the right and left swivelings.
Obtain their respective measurements. Do not calculate for their average.
4. Before operation, make sure nobody is around the machine.
[Measurement conditions]
1. Engine rpm is max..
2. Hydraulic temperature is 50 ± 5°C, 122 ± 9°F.
3. Ground is flat.
4. Measure time after several pre-operation.
IV-S-56
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
IV-S-57
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
IV-S-58
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
(b)
(A)
(a)
(a)
(A)
(a)
(A) (B)
IV-S-59
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
b.Pump
1. Pump assy dismount
1. Disconnect the delivery hoses
2. Plug the joints.
IV-S-60
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
IV-S-61
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
(16)(17)(18)
IV-S-62
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
Notes:
1. To pour hydraulic oil, remove the plug (Easy
Touch). After adding the oil, be sure to attach the
plug (Easy Touch). Then get the engine started.
2. With the plug (Easy Touch) in place, pull it gently
to make sure it does not come off.
(1)
(2)
IV-S-63
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
P3
P1
(1)Inlet port.
(2)LS control valve.
(1)
(2)
IV-S-64
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
P1
P1 P2
PLS
P2 P3
(3) P1+P2
(2) 2
(4)P3
(3)
(4)
P1 Delivery port
P1
P2
P3
(1)Horse power control valve
P2
(1)
P3
(4)
(6)
IV-S-65
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
(4)
(1)
(3) (2)
IV-S-66
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
2) LS control valve.
1) 5 ports
1) Pump pressure sensing line
2) 2) HPC pilot line
3) HPC pilot line
3) 4) Pilot pump pressure after the fixd orifice
5) Pilot pump pressure before the fixed orifice
6) Pps port
4)
5)
3) Inner parts.
IV-S-67
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
3) Inner parts.
IV-S-68
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
IV-S-69
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
(1)
(2)
(4)
(5)
(3)
IV-S-70
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
5) Control pin.
IV-S-71
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
3) Springs
(4)
(1)Inner control spring
(2)Outer control spring
(3)Assist spring
(4)Spring seat
(4)
(1)
(2) (3)
IV-S-72
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
(4)
6) Inner parts of the cylinder block
(1)Pistons
(2)Cylinder
(3)Cone
(4)Springs
(2)
(1)
(3)
7) Springs
8) Piston
9) Spring seat
IV-S-73
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
IV-S-74
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
7) Disassembled parts.
(1)Main shaft
(2)Bearing
(3)Snap ring
(1)
(3)
(2)
IV-S-75
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
(1)Knock pin
IV-S-76
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
3) Pp delivery port
3. Mounting bolts
M12 x 152
IV-S-77
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
IV-S-78
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
9. Inner parts
IV-S-79
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
IV-S-80
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
IV-S-81
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
d.Control valve
1.Adaptor and joint
1)Fitting the valve assembly (control), bracket
(1, valve), bracket (2, valve) and bracket (3,
valve) Set them up in the following steps.
a)Fit the three brackets (1, valve) (2, valve)
and (3, valve) onto the valve assembly
(control). Temporarily tighten the bolts.
b)Place the valve assembly (control) on the
base (valve).
c)Tighten up the bolts (1) specified in the figure
to fix the bracket (3, valve) onto the base
(valve).
d)Tighten up the bolts (2) specified in the figure
to fix the valve assembly (control) to the
bracket (3, valve).
e)Tighten up the bolts (3) specified in the figure
to fix the brackets (1, valve) and (2, valve)
onto the base (valve).
f)Finally tighten up the bolts (4) as shown at
left to fix the valve assembly (control).
(A)(Machine front)
L:(Left)
4 (1)(2) R:(Right)
3 D:(Down)
Lo:(LOW)
PB1
Pbu1
PA I (a) PP1 B:(Backward)
Pb k 5
L AK5 BK5 R (b) C:(Crowded)
U (3) Pb k 4
D AK4 BK4 (c)
Pb k 3
U:(Up)
Lo AK3 BK3 Hi (d) Hi:(HIGH)
P3 T2 (e) PF2
PP2
F:(Forward)
B AK2 BK2 F (f) Pb k 2 Du:(Dump)
B F (g)
(1)Bracket (1, valve)
AK1 BK1
Pb k 1
P2 P1
(h)
PPS
(2)Bolt
1 (3)Base (valve)
T1 P (i) PF1 PP3
(4)Bracket (3, valve)
(4) Pb1 (5)Bolt
C Du (j)
A1 B1
IV-S-82
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
(A)Adaptor at port T1
(B)Fitting direction of the valve assembly (return)
(5)
(c)
IV-S-83
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
(10) (42)
(30)
(43)
(11) (23) (30) A
(44)
(12) (HIGH)
(44)
(12) (45)
(31) (46)
IV-S-84
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
(a)[PS bypass]
(b)[Swivel] (left)
(c)[Dozer] (bottom)
(d)[S/P2] (low)
(e)[Confluence valve]
(f)[Travel] (left backward)
(g)[Travel] (right backward)
(h)[Travel independent valve]
(i)[Arm] (bottom)
(j)[Bucket] (bottom)
(k)[S/P] (low)
(l)[Boom] (rod)
(m)[Swing] (left)
(n)(Right)
(o)(Rod)
(p)(HIGH)
(q)(Left forward)
(r)(Right forward)
(s)(Rod)
(t)(Rod)
(u)(HIGH)
(v)(Bottom)
(w)(Right)
(m)
(a) (b) (c) (d) (e) (f) (g)
(h)
(i) (j) (k) (l)
IV-S-85
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
IV-S-86
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
2. Lifting eye-bolt
M10x1.5
IV-S-87
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
8. Side view.
IV-S-88
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
IV-S-89
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
(1)Compenstaion spool
(2)High pressure selection poppet
(2) (1)
IV-S-90
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
IV-S-91
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
IV-S-92
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
2) Other side
3) Inner parts
IV-S-93
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
2. Travel R section
1) Outer view
2) Other side
3) Inner parts
IV-S-94
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
3. Travel L section
1) Outer view
2) Other side
3) Inner parts
IV-S-95
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
4. P3 inlet section
1) Outer view
2) Other side
3) Inner parts
4) P3 confluence spool
5) Pilot port
IV-S-96
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
7) Orifice (PP2)
8) Screen (PP2)
IV-S-97
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
2) Other side
4) Inner parts
IV-S-98
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
6. Dozer section
1) Outer view
(1)
2) Other side
3) Inner parts
IV-S-99
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
7. Swivel section
1) Outer view
2) Other side
3) Inner parts
IV-S-100
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
8. P3 confluence valve
1) Outer view
2) Other side
3) Inner parts
IV-S-101
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
2) Other side
LS main relief valve Unload valve
IV-S-102
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
5) Inner parts
(1)LS main relief valve
(2)Unload valve
(2)
(1)
(3)
(3)
(1) (2)
7) Side view
(4)Unload valve
(4)
IV-S-103
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
2) Other side
3) Inner parts
4) Anti-void valve
(2)Spool ID mark
(1)
(2)
IV-S-104
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
IV-S-105
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
e. pilot valve
1.Fitting the adaptor
Port P
Filter
Pipe joint
Ports T, 1, 2, 3 and 4
Pipe joint
3 Bucket dump Red 6.Fitting the plate (1, partition) and plate (2,
4 Boom up Green partition)
P Port P White When winding the thermal insulation around the
T Port T None
valve, be careful not to wrap the wire harness
together.
((A)(Viewed from the operator's seat)
(1) (A) (13)
L: R: L:Left P/V
(2) (14)
R:Right P/V
(3) (15)
(4) (16) (a)(Back)
(5) (17) (b)(Front)
IV-S-106
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
1 Dozer P/V
Location Hose tape color
2 1 Dozer (down) Brown
P T
2 Dozer (up) Pink
P Port P White
(c)
(14)(15)(16)
IV-S-107
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
4.Quick-coupling adaptor
Pipe joint
Make sure the hose connection is free from
detrimental scratches.
Swing P/V
Location Hose tape color
P Port P White
T Port T None
R:(Right swing)
L:(Left swing)
IV-S-108
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
IV-S-109
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
1. Overall structure
1)
2)
3)
4)
)5.2
)6.0
IV-S-110
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
(A)
h.Travel pilot valve
(a)
(1)
1.Fitting the adaptor
R: L:
(2)
Ports P and T
Pipe joint (bushing G1/4)
(3)
Pipe joint (cross, G1/4)
(4) Plug
(5) Ports 1, 2, 3 and 4
Pipe joint
5.Quick-coupling adaptor
Pipe joint
Make sure the hose connection is free from
detrimental scratches.
IV-S-111
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
7.Troubleshooting and corrective measures failureonlywitha singlepart, but caused bya failure
involving more than one part.
Troubleshooting is not easy. Some assumed For this reason, be aware of the fact that
causes are listed in the table below. Since repair is corrections may also be necessary other than
difficult, refer to the assumed causes and listed.
corrective measures in the table. Also, the table below does not cover al I the
Symptoms, assumed causes, and corrective assumed causes and corrective measures.
measures in general are listed in the table below. The persons in charge of repair must further
In most cases, a trouble isnot caused bya investigate problems and causes as necessary.
[1] Sticking portion in siiding part [1] Correct the sticking portion.
Secondary pressure is [2] ReturntheoiI intotheoiI tank directly.
[2] Fluctuations in tank line pressure
unstable. [3] Bleed the pipe several times.
[3] Air trapped in thepipe
Secondary pressure is too [1] Tank line pressure is high. [1] Return to the oiI into the oiI tank directly.
high. [2] Stickingportion in siidingpart [2] Correct the sticking portion.
[1] Air is trapped inside the piston chamber. [1] Bleed the air several times.
[2] Sticking portion in siiding part [2] Correct the sticking portion.
[3] The damping springs (336, 337) no longer have [3] Replace with a new one.
Damping function does not enough elasticity. [4] Replace the damping piston and casing assembly.
work. [4] The gap between the dampingpiston (224) and the [5] Disassemble and investigate the check valve por-
casing is too wide. tion.
[5] Malfunction of the check valve [6] Replace the damping piston.
[6] The orifice of the damping piston is too large.
IV-S-112
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
8. Disassembling procedures
1) Operational precautions in general
1. Prepare a solid and rattle-free working bench
that is wide enough to place parts on and that
does not allow the parts to drop or move.
2. Prepare tools and materials.
3. Sinee the parts are very precise, handIe
themwith much care not to bump them each
other or drop them.
4. Do not hit or wrench the parts even when they
are hardly moved. Otherwise, burrs may be
generated or the parts may be damaged,
causing an oil leakage or degradation in
performance. Always work with patience with
much care.
5. Leaving the parts disassembled may cause
them to rust as a result of humidity or
contamination. If it is absolutely necessary to
stopworking before reassembIing, pay
attention to prevent rust and dust.
2) DisassembIing procedures
1.Clean the pilot valve with kerosene.
Close each port with a blind plug.
IV-S-113
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
IV-S-114
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
Caution
Caution
IV-S-115
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
Caution
Caution
IV-S-116
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
Caution
IV-S-117
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
IV-S-118
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
IV-S-119
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
(RCVD8CC only)
(RCVD8CC only)
(RCVD8CC only)
IV-S-120
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
IV-S-121
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
9. Assembling instructions
1) Operational precautions in general
(1)As done for disassembling, prepare a
working bench and tools.
(2)Pay attention as done for disassembling.
(3)Before assembling, remove bits of metal or
foreign material from all the parts, and also
check that there is no burrs or dents on the
parts. If you find burrs or dents, remove
them with an oilstone.
(4)As a rule, replace all 0-rings and NHU
packing with new one.
(5 Install the 0-rings and NHU packing, taking
care not to damage them. (Apply a little
amount of grease for smooth installation.)
(6)To prevent the parts from dropping, use
grease.
(7)Tighten the bolts with the torque shown in
the assembly cross-section drawing.
(8)After the assembling is completed, close
all the ports with plugs to prevent dust from
entering.
2) AssembIing procedures
(RCVD8CC only)
(RCVD8CC only)
IV-S-122
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
(RCVD8CC only)
IV-S-123
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
IV-S-124
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
Caution
IV-S-125
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
IV-S-126
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
1)NHU packing
IV-S-127
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
IV-S-128
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
IV-S-129
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
IV-S-130
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
IV-S-131
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
IV-S-132
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
i.Swive. motor
1.Fitting the adaptor
Fit the adaptor in position as shown at left.
IV-S-133
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
(1)(2)
(3)(4)
(5)
(6)(7)
(8)
(9)(10)
(11)(12)
(13)
IV-S-134
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
2.Hose routing
See (2/2).
As shown in Fig. 2, keep the hoses free from too
tight contact, such as twist or crossing, inside the
track frame.
Dozer
(15) (14)
(16)
Length
Route Part name Tape color
mm(inch)
S/J(E)-Motor right bottom (A) Hydraulic hose (5/8) Yellow W (right front) 1355(53.3)
S/J(G)-Motor right top (B) Hydraulic hose (5/8) Green W (right back) 1355(53.3)
S/J(D)-Motor left top (A) Hydraulic hose (5/8) Red W (left front) 1355(53.3)
S/J(F)-Motor left bottom (B) Hydraulic hose (5/8) Blue W (left back) 1355(53.3)
S/J(A)-Motor left/right bi-speed Hydraulic hose (1/4) 1385(54.5)
S/J(H)-Motor left/right drain Hydraulic hose (3/8) 1310(51.6)
S/J(C)-Dozer relay Hydraulic hose (1/2) Pink 430(16.9)
S/J(B)-Dozer relay Hydraulic hose (1/2) Brown 430(16.9)
Dozer relay-Dozer cylinder (rod) Hydraulic hose (1/2) Pink 790(31.1)
Dozer relay – Dozer cylinder (bottom) Hydraulic hose (1/2) Brown 790(31.1)
IV-S-135
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
CAUTION
If the GM motor is hoisted for moving or setting
up, never step in below the suspended motor.
You may get injured.
NOTE
Use lock bolts with the JIS Strength Class 10.9
or higher.
2. Piping
*The GM motor has been delivered with covers
or plugs at the pipe ports. This is to keep out
dust, weld scale and other foreign substances.
Remove such covers or plugs before
connecting the pipes.
CAUTION
Before connecting the pipes, make sure the GM
motor turning direction and the pipe port loca-
tions are as specified (referring to the Dimen-
sional Outline Drawing). If in the wrong turning
direction, you may get injured.
IV-S-136
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
NOTE
Before getting the motor started, be sure to fill
the motor casing with hydraulic oil.
Oil amount required in the casing: 0.5 liters
(0.13 US gal.)
Otherwise the hydraulic motor may reach its
service life earlier than expected.
IV-S-137
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
IV-S-138
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
NOTE
Oil may gush out when removing the plugs.
Turn them slowly to relieve the internal
pressure.
1) 2)
3)
(1)Stop the GM motor so that the oil level check 1)Oil level check port (PF 3/8)
port comes to the top and the oil drain port to 2)Oil filler port (PF 3/8)
3)Oil drain port (PF 3/8)
the bottom. (See the above figure.)
(4)To add oil, remove the oil filler port and oil
level check port plugs. If the oil has been let
out, tighten the oil drain port plug.
Tightening torque:
58.8r9.8N-m (6.0r1.0kgf.m) 43.4r7.2 ft.lbs
IV-S-139
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
c. Troubleshooting
Phenomenon 1 Phenomenon 2 Possible cause Correction
Relief pressure setting too low Make correct setting.
No pressure rise Pump defective Repair.
Directional control valve defective Repair.
Failure to run Brake valve defective Replace or repair the brake valve.
Proper pressure Hydraulic motor defective Repair.
rise Reduction gears damaged Replace the GM motor.
Overloaded Remove the cause of overload.
Mating surface scratched Smooth the surface with whetstone, sand-
Leak at mating paper or the like.
surfaces
Loose bolt Retighten up.
Loose plug Retighten up.
Leak at casing
Broken by stone or the like Replace the GM motor.
Oil leak Leak at floating Sliding face worn out Replace the GM motor.
seal O-ring crept Replace the GM motor.
Loose bolt Retighten up.
Leak at hydraulic O-ring damaged Replace the O-ring
motor Sealing surface scratched Smooth the surface with whetstone, sand-
paper or the like.
Hydraulic motor volumetric efficiency drop Replace the GM motor.
More hydraulic oil
Load-caused run leak Brake valve internally leaky Replace or repair the brake valve.
in operation
Parking brake not Spring damaged Replace the spring.
working Friction disc worn out Replace the friction and mating discs.
Gear oil short Add oil up to the proper level.
Reduction gears casing surface
Pitching at bearing Replace the GM motor.
temperature too high
Hydraulic oil into the casing Replace the oil seal.
Left and right discharge rates not equal Repair the pump.
At low pressure Left and right hydraulic motor drain amounts Replace the GM motor.
not equal
Zigzag travel Left and right discharge rates not equal Repair the pump or control valve.
(when used as Left and right hydraulic motor drain amounts Replace the GM motor.
travel motor) not equal
At high pressure
Left and right brake valve actions not equal Replace the brake valve.
Relief pressure drop at left or right control Make correct pressure setting. Replace
valve the relief valve.
Pump discharge Pump malfunctioning Repair or replace the pump.
No speed-up rate short Too much leak out of pump Repair or replace the pump.
Too much leak out of hydraulic motor Replace the GM motor.
Hydraulic motor or reduction gears dam- Replace the GM motor.
Unusual At GM motor
aged
operating noise
At piping Piping vibrated Clamp the piping.
High-pressure check valve malfunctioning Repair or replace.
Failure to switch
Selector valve malfunctioning Repair or replace.
from low to high
Two-speed speed Pilot pressure too low Set to the specified pressure.
selection Two-speed selector piston malfunctioning Repair or replace.
impossible Failure to switch Selector valve malfunctioning Repair or replace.
from high to low Two-speed selector piston malfunctioning Repair or replace.
speed
IV-S-140
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
1. SERVICE OUTLINE
1-1. Tools
1-1.1. Standard tools
Applicable parts
Name Description Remarks Q'ty
(Usage method or parts No.)
33, 121, 126, 143, 144, 152, 154 Torquewrench Dialtype, approx. 180N JIS B 4650 1
154 Nominal 4 1
Nominal200
19 Extension bar 1
Insert angle 19mm
1 Centerpunch ø9.5X100 1
Volume:
For oil draining and holding balls Receptacles 3
W450XD300XH120
17 Metal-net basket 2
IV-S-141
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
For disassembling
General work stand 1
And reassembling works
Press capacity:
104, 149 Press 1
1960 N (200 kgf) 441lbs
Volume:
Diameter:
1 Drill 1
2 mm (0.08 in)
GM motor, 1, 2 Crane 1
3 Lathe 1
Grinder 1
Pressure:
For drying washed parts Compressed air supply 0.29 - 0.49 Mpa 1
Measurement:
Thickness gauge 2
0.04-0.3 mm(0.002~0.01 in.)
Measurement range:
IV-S-142
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
IV-S-143
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
IV-S-144
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
"A"
Hub M14
Spindle M16
GM motor M16
IV-S-145
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
IV-S-146
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
58.8 r 9.81 N. m
221 Hexagon socket plug PF3/8 8mm 3 (6 r 1.0 kgf.m)
43.4 r 7.2 ft.lbs
IV-S-147
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
Caution
Caution
IV-S-148
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
2-3.Disassembly procedure
(1 ) Washing the travel motor
1) Fasten the eyebolts in the screw holes for
mounting the spindle [2].
Caution
IV-S-149
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
1)(Gap of ring}
2)Cover
3)Ring
4)Hub
IV-S-150
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
IV-S-151
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
Caution
IV-S-152
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
IV-S-153
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
IV-S-154
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
IV-S-155
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
IV-S-156
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
1) Piston seal
2) Valve
IV-S-157
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
Caution
IV-S-158
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
IV-S-159
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
IV-S-160
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
1)Press
2)Washer
3)Retalner
4)Snap ring
5)Spring
6)Cylinder brock
Caution
(15)Shaft removal
1) Remove the swash plate [103] from the
spindle [2].
IV-S-161
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
1)Press
2)Retainer(1)
IV-S-162
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
Caution
IV-S-163
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
(18)Fixture removal
1)Invert the travel motor.
(19)Spindle removal
1) Fasten two eyebolts in the mounting holes
of the spindle [2] so they are symmetrically
positioned.
IV-S-164
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
IV-S-165
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
1) Oil seal
2) Spindle
IV-S-166
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
Caution
IV-S-167
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
IV-S-168
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
0.0016in. 0.0016in.
(9.9kgf . m) (9.9kgf . m)
71.6ft . lbs 71.6ft . lbs
IV-S-169
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
IV-S-170
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
Caution
IV-S-171
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
IV-S-172
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
IV-S-173
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
IV-S-174
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
IV-S-175
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
IV-S-176
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
Caution
Caution
IV-S-177
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
IV-S-178
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
IV-S-179
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
IV-S-180
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
IV-S-181
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
IV-S-182
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
1)Piston seal
2)Valve
IV-S-183
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
IV-S-184
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
IV-S-185
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
IV-S-186
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
IV-S-187
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
IV-S-188
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
"C"="A"-"B"
A : Actual measurement value
B : Jig bodydimension
C : Specified dimension
IV-S-189
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
1) Depth micrometer
2) Jig
IV-S-190
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
IV-S-191
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
IV-S-192
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
(113~131°F)
(104~176°F)
IV-S-193
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
IV-S-194
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
1) Hub
Spindle kit
*Spindle assembly
2) **Spindle
3) **Hold flange
19) *Reamer bolt
RV gear assembly
*RV gear kit
4) **RV gear A
5) **RV gear B
9) *Crank shaft
12) *Specer
22) *Tapered roller bearing
23) *Needle roller bearing
6) Input gear
Spur gear kit
7) Sper gear
F-Seal kit
31) Floating seal
8) Cover
15) Shaft (G)
17) Pin
18) Ring
20) Snap ring
21) Ball bearing
24) Snap ring
25) Snap ring
28) O-ring
29) O-ring
30) O-ring
33) Plug
34) Plug
35) O-ring
36) Steel ball
43) Parallel pin
102) Shaft
103) Swash plate
104) Cylinder block
Piston kit
*Pisdton assembly
105) **Piston
106)**Shoe
107)Retainer plate
108) Thrust ball
109) Timing plate
110) Washer
112) Piston
113) Spring
114) Sptring
115) Friction plate
116) Mating plate
132) Oil seal
135) O-ring
141) O-ring
146) Snap ring
149) Ball bearing
150) Ball bearing
151) Needle roller
Piston assembly
161) *Piston
162) *shoe
176) Pivot
177) Parallel pin
185) Spring
Rear Flange assembly
*Rear flange kit
201) **Rear flange
223) Spool
286) **piston
252) **Hex.. Socket plug
268) **Steel ball
275) **Hex.. Socket plug
279) **Filter
280) **Orifce
283) **Plug
298) **Orifce
299) **Name plate
*Sppl kit
271) **Spool
272) **Oil stopper
221) *Plug
224) *Plug
225) *Spring retainer
227) *valve
228) *Spring
230) *Spring
236) *O-ring
238) *O-ring
281) *Spring
282) *Plug
284) *Plug
285) *O-ring
287) *valve
288) *Sleeve
289) *Plug
290) *Spring
291) *O-ring
292) *O-ring
293) *Piston seal
294) *Back up ring
295) *Back up ring
296) *Steel ball
297) *Orifice
242) Parallel pin
245 Hex.. Socket bolt
IV-S-195
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
(6)
(4) (5)
(14)
(7)
(8)
(C) (9)
(15)
(10)
(11)
(a)
(b) (f)
(12) (d)
(c)
(13) (e)
IV-S-196
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
l. Holding valve
1) Boom cylinder
2) Holding Valve assy
IV-S-197
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
IV-S-198
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
m. Hydraulic tank
(1) Tank assy
(4)Connector
IV-S-199
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
(A)Machine front
IV-S-200
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
n.Filters
(1)(2) 1.Fitting the adaptor
Fit the adaptor in position as shown at left.
(1)Pipe (return)
(2)Bolt
(3)Pipe joint (LG12, G12)
(4)Pipe joint (LG6, G6)
(5)Elbow pipe joint
(6)Adaptor
(7)O ring
(6)(7)
IV-S-201
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
No. 1 port
Pipe joint (SG6, 1U)
(4) (6) (RD809-6151D)
(5)
(7) No. 2 port
C/V Pipe joint (LG6, G6)
(RD809-6917D)
(8) No. 3 port
(9) Pipe joint (LG6, G6)
(10)
(RD809-6154D)
IV-S-202
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
4.Quick-coupling adaptor
Pipe joint
(9) Pipe joint
Pipe joint
(10) Make sure the hose connection is free from
detrimental
1 Port P White
2 Port T None
(A)(Machine front)
IV-S-203
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
5.Quick-coupling adaptor
Pipe joint
Pipe joint
Pipe joint
Make sure the hose connection is free from
detrimental scratches.
(5)
(A)(Machine front)
IV-S-204
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
8 Spare None
9 Spare None
(A)(Machine front)
(1)Nut
(2)Bracket (pilot hose)
(3)Bolt
IV-S-205
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
3.Quick-coupling adaptor
Pipe joint
Pipe joint
Make sure the hose connection is free from
detrimental scratches.
(1)(2)(3)
(4)(5)(6)
(a)(Relay plate)
(b)(To boom H/V)
(12) (c)(Machine front)
(d)(Swivel center)
(d) (1)Pipe joint (L, G1/4-G1/4)
(A) (a) 20mm(0.79inch) (2)O ring
12mm(0.47inch) (3)Pipe joint (QL, G1/4-8.4)
(13)(14) (4)Pipe joint (L, G1/4-G1/4)
(5)O ring
(b) (6)Pipe joint (S, G1/4-8.4)
(7)Pipe joint (L, G1/4-G1/4)
(8)O ring
(c) (9)Pipe joint (T, G2-G2-G2)
(10)Pipe joint (S, G1/4-8.4)
(11)Pipe joint (QL, G1/4-8.4)
(12)Pipe joint (QL, G1/4-8.4)
(13)Adaptor (pilot hose, 2)
(14)Bolt
(15)Pipe joint (bushing G1/4)
(16)O ring
(17)Pipe joint (QL, G1/4-8.4)
(15)(16)(17) (18)Pipe joint (QL, G1/4-8.4)
(18) (19)Pipe joint (bushing G1/4)
(20)Pipe joint (QL, G1/4-8.4)
(19)(20) (21)Pipe joint (bushing G1/4)
(22)O ring
(23)Pipe joint (QL, G1/4-8.4)
(21)(22)(23)
IV-S-206
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
(1)
(2)
(3)
(7)
(4)
(5)
(6)
IV-S-207
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
(1)
t.Unload valve
1. Fitting the adaptor
(2)(3) Fit the adaptor in position as shown at left.
(8)(9)
(10) (11)
(1)Accumulator
(2)Pipe joint (T, F2-F3)
(3)O ring
(4)Pipe joint (L, G1/4-G1/4)
(12)(13) (5)O ring
(6)Straight pipe joint(3-3-45)
(7)Pipe joint(L, G3/8-G1/2)
(8)Pipe joint (L, G3/8-G3/8)
(9)O ring
(10)Valve assembly (unload)
(11)Bolt
(12)Straight pipe joint
(13)O ring
IV-S-208
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
D-D
u.SP1 and SP2 solenoid valve
(1)(2) (3)
1. Fitting the adaptor
Fit the adaptor in position as shown at left.
Tightening torque
48.1~55.9N.m(4.9~5.7kgf.m)35.4~41.2ft.lbs
(12)
Tightening torque
(11) 23.5~27.5N.m(2.4~2.8kgf.m)17.4~20.3ft.lbs
(17)(18)
(1)Valve assembly (proportional)
(2)Bolt
(3)C/V(SP1 LOW)
(14)(15)(16) (4)C/V(SP1 HIGH)
(13) (5)Valve assembly(unload)
(6)Bolt
(7)Pipe joint (L, G1/4-G1/4)
(8)C/V(SP2 HIGH)
(9)C/V(SP2 LOW)
(10)(Unload, port B)
(11)(SP1)
(12)(Tank)
(13)Pipe joint (QL, G1/4-8.4)
(14)Pipe joint (S, G1/4-G1/4)
(15)O ring
(16)Pipe joint (QL, G1/4-8.4)
(17)Bracket (valve, SP)
(18)Bolt
(19)T pipe joint (F2)
(20)O ring
(21)Adaptor
(22)O ring
(25) (23)Washer-fitted elbow
(24)O ring
(25)(SP2)
(26)(Tank)
(19)(20)
(21)(22) (26)
(23)(24)
IV-S-209
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
(1)(2)
v.Pilot pump relay block
1. Fitting the adaptor
(3)(4) Fit the adaptor in position as shown at left.
(5)(6) 2. Adaptor tightening torque
G1/4 size
(7)(8) 24.5~29.4N.m(2.5~3.0kgf.m)18.1~21.7ft.lbs
4. Quick-coupling adaptor
Pipe joint
Pipe joint
Make sure the hose connection is free from
detrimental scratches.
(a)(Unload P)
(b)(Swivel motor PG)
(a)
(C/V PP1)
(b)
(C/V PP2)
(C/V PP3)
(10)(11)
IV-S-210
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
(7)
(6)
IV-S-211
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
x.Cylinders
1 .Fitting the adaptor of each cylinder
Fit the adaptors at the angle specified in the
figure.
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
(7)
(6) (5)
E E-E
(1)(Swing cylinder)
(2)Pipe joint (LG4, 11/16U)
(3)Pipe joint (SG4, 11/16U)
(4)(Boom cylinder)
(5)Pipe joint (SG4, 1U)
(6)Pipe joint (SG4, 13/16U)
(7)Clamp
Bolt
IV-S-212
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
(2)
(1) F F-F
F
(3)
(4)
(5)
(6)
(7)
(1)(Arm cylinder)
(2)Clamp
Bolt
(3)Pipe joint (SG4, 13/16U)
(4)Pipe joint (bushing, 1/2)
Pipe joint (SG4, 1U)
(5)(Bucket cylinder)
(6)Pipe joint (LG4, 13/16U)
(7)Pipe joint (LG4, 1U)
IV-S-213
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
y.Hydraulic hose
1.Metallic sealing type
2.Quick-coupling type
G1-1/4 size
Couple the hose in position as shown at left.
Finally, make sure the hose does not come off.
IV-S-214
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
z.Hose route
1.Pilot hose 1 Pilot hoses
No. Location Tapecolor Q'ty
2 (P4, T) Collective block ~ Dozer P/V (P) Dozer P/V boost White 1
4 (P4, T) Collective block ~ Travel P/V (P) Travel P/V boost White 1
5 Travel P/V (P) ~ Swing P/V (P) Swing P/V boost White 1
(A) (B)
(D) (E)
(C)
F: F:
(F)
B: B:
(G)
IV-S-215
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
2.Pilot hose 2
Pilot hoses
No. Location Tapecolor Q'ty
6 P/V (swivel left) – Shuttle valve Swivel (left) Gray 1
7 P/V (swivel right) – Shuttle valve Swivel (left) Sky-blue 1
8 P/V (arm crowded) – Relay adaptor Arm (crowded) Blue 1
9 Relay adaptor – Relay plate (arm crowded) Arm (crowded) Blue 1
10 P/V (arm crowded) – Relay adaptor Arm (dump) Yellowish green 1
11 Relay adaptor – Shuttle valve (arm crowded) Arm (dump) Yellowish green 1
12 P/V (bucket crowded) – Relay plate Bucket (crowded) Orange 1
13 P/V (bucket dump) – Relay plate Bucket (dump) Red 1
14 P/V (boom up) – Relay adaptor Boom (up) Green 1
15 Relay adaptor – Relay plate (boom up) Boom (up) Green 1
16 P/V (boom down) – Relay adaptor Boom (down) Yellow 1
17 Relay adaptor – Relay plate (boom down) Boom (down) Yellow 1
18 Dozer P/V (up) – Relay plate Dozer (up) Pink 1
19 Dozer P/V (down) – Relay plate Dozer (down) Brown 1
(a)
(b) (c)
(d)
(e)
(A)
(f)
(g) (i) (j)
(h)
(k) (l)
(m)
F: F:
B: B: (n)
(p)
(q)
(u)
(v)
(s) (r)
(w) (x)
(o)
(t)
IV-S-216
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
3.Pilot hose 3
(a)
(a)Pump assembly (piston)
(b)Filter assembly (hydraulic)
(c) (c)Swivel joint assembly
(d)Adaptor (pilot hose, 1)
(e)Valve assembly (unload)
(f)Oil flow
(b)
(f)
IV-S-217
(e)
(d)
PAC
B
A
Hydraulic system
4 Selector valve (B) ~ SP2 solenoid valve (P) SP2 (feed) Blue 1
5 SP2 solenoid valve (P) ~ SP1 solenoid valve (P) SP1 (feed) 1
7 Selector valve (P) ~ P4 distribution block (tank side) Distribution block (feed) White 1
8 P4 distribution block (tank side) ~ C/V (PP1) AI boost Blue 1
(a) (b)
(a)Control valve assembly
(b)Valve assembly (unload)
(c)Valve assembly (unload)
(f) (d)Valve assembly (proportional)
(e)Motor assembly (swivel)
(f)Joint (block, PP)
(c)
IV-S-218
(d)
(e)
Hydraulic system
31 SP2 solenoid (high pressure) – C/V (SP1 high pressure) SP2 (high pressure) Pink
32 SP2 solenoid (low pressure) – C/V (SP1 low pressure) SP2 (low pressure) Brown
Pbu 1
PB1 PAI
(a) (A)Control valve assembly
AK5
R: L:
BK5 21 (B)Valve assembly (unload)
AK4
(b) BK4 23 (C)Valve assembly (PV, travel)
D: U:
AK3
(c) BK3
(D)Valve assembly (proportional)
Lo: Hi:
(k) (o) (E)(Used for the swing pedal)
P3 T2
27 Valve assembly (pilot, OFF)
(d) PF2 PP2
AK2 BK2
Bw: Fw:
(e) (p) (a)Swivel
AK1
Bw: Fw:
BK1 (l)
(r)
(b)Dozer
P2 P1 (q) (AA) (c)SP2
(m) (d)Travel left
(n) (e)Travel right
(f)Arm
T1 P
19 17 14 (g)Bucket
(f)
PF1 PP3 (h)SP1
A1
Cr:C Du:
B1
11 (i)Boom
A2
(g)
B2
(j)Swing
Cr: Du: (k)Dozer (up)
(h)
A3
Lo: Hi:
B3 (l)Bucket (dump)
A4
(i)
B4
(m)Boom (up)
D: U: (n)Boom (down)
PB2
(o)Dozer (down)
PLS (E) (p)Adaptor (pilot hose, 1)
(j)
A5
L: R:
B5 (q)Arm(dump)(r)
Bucket (crowded)
12 (r)Swivel (left) L: R:
(s)Arm (crowded) (AA)(View A)
Hydraulic system
13 (t)Swivel (right) L:(Left)
R:(Right)
20 (u)Valve assembly D:Down
15 (swivel shuttle) U:Up
26 Lo:Low
25 Hi:High
16 Bw:Backward
Fw:Forward
Cr:Crowded
Du:Dump
R:Right
L:Left
D:Down
U:Up
Lo:Low
IV-S-220
Hi:High
Bw:Backward
(c) Fw:Forward
Cr:Crowded
(f)
R: L: Du:Dump
(g)
D: U:
(h)
(a)Pump assembly (piston)
Lo: Hi: (b)Valve assembly(3-way)
(c)Motor assembly (swivel)
(i)
(d)Control valve assembly
Bw: Fw: (e)Swivel joint assembly
(j) (f)Swivel
Bw: Fw:
(g)Dozer
(h)SP2
(i)Travel left
(j)Travel right
(k)Arm
(l)Bucket
(k) (d) (m)SP1
Cr: Du: (n)Boom
(l)
Cr: Du: (o)Swing
(m)
Lo: Hi: R:Right
(n)
D: U: L:Left
D:Down
(e) U:Up
(o) Lo:Low
L: R:
Hi:High
Bw:Backward
Fw:Forward
Hydraulic system
Cr:Crowded
Du:Dump
(a)Pipe (return)
(b)Valve assembly (3-way)
(c)Hydraulic tank
(d)Motor assembly (swivel)
(e)Control valve assembly
(f)Oil cooler
(g)(Machine front)
IV-S-221
(c) (g)
(b)
(f)
(d)
(e)
Hydraulic system
8.Pump delivery
(4)
P3
‚o‚R
‚o‚P
‚o2
D
B-B
A-A
B
B
(2)
(3)
(1)
C
D
¦
C
E
‚o‚R
‚o‚P
‚o2
C-C
A
P4
PPS
A
PLS
E
P2
P1
PPS
PLS
IV-S-222
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
9.Suction
(1)
(2)
(3)
IV-S-223
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
(1)
(2)
(4)
(3)
(5)
(6)
IV-S-224
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
(9)
(10)
(11)
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
M16
M24
(5)
(12)
IV-S-225
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
12.Front hoses and pipes
Hydraulic system
(18)
(1) (7)(8)(9)
(2)(3)(4)
(10)(11)(12)(13)
(5)(6)
IV-S-227
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Hydraulic system
(3)
(12)
(4)
(5) (13)
(6)
(7) (14)
(8)
(15)
(9) (16)
(10)(11)
(17)(18)
(2)
(1) (19)(20)
IV-S-228
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
aa.Hose route :
14 Shuttle valve ~ C/V (arm crowded) Hydraulic hose (1/4, arm C3) 1860(73.2) Blue Quick G1/4
15 Relay plate ~ C/V (arm dump) Hydraulic hose (1/4, arm D3) 1500(59.1) Yellowish green Quick Quick
16 Relay plate ~ C/V (bucket crowded) Hydraulic hose (1/4, bucket C2) 2000(78.7) Orange Quick G1/4
17 Relay plate ~ C/V (bucket dump) Hydraulic hose (1/4, bucket D2) 1470(57.9) Red Quick Quick
18 Relay plate ~ C/V (boom confluence Pbu) Hydraulic hose (1/4, boom U3) 1760(69.3) Green Quick Quick
19 C/V (boom confluence Pbu) ~ C/V (boom up) Hydraulic hose (1/4, boom confluence) 860(33.9) Green Quick Quick
20 Relay plate ~ C/V (boom down) Hydraulic hose (1/4, boom D3) 2000(78.7) Yellow Quick G1/4
21 Travel P/V (left forward) ~ C/V (left forward) Hydraulic hose (1/4, travel LF) 1660(65.4) Red Quick Quick
22 Travel P/V (left backward) ~ C/V (left backward) Hydraulic hose (1/4, travel LR) 1950(76.8) Blue Quick G1/4
23 Travel P/V (right forward) ~ C/V (right forward) Hydraulic hose (1/4, travel RF) 1550(61.0) Yellow Quick Quick
24 Travel P/V (right backward) ~ C/V (right backward) Hydraulic hose (1/4, travel RR) 1840(72.4) Green Quick G1/4
25 Swing P/V (left) ~ C/V (swing left) Hydraulic hose (1/4, swing L) 1850(72.8) Orange Quick G1/4
26 Swing P/V (right) ~ C/V (swing right) Hydraulic hose (1/4, swing R) 1450(57.1) Yellowish green Quick Quick
27 Relay plate ~ C/V (dozer up) Hydraulic hose (1/4, dozer U2) 1570(61.8) Pink Quick Quick
28 Relay plate ~ C/V (dozer down) Hydraulic hose (1/4, dozer D2) 1900(74.8) Brown Quick G1/4
29 SP1 solenoid (high pressure) ~ C/V (SP1 high pressure) Hydraulic hose (1/4, SP1H) 790(31.1) Pink Quick Quick
Hydraulic system
30 SP1 solenoid (low pressure) ~ C/V (SP1 low pressure) Hydraulic hose (1/4, SP1L) 1040(40.9) Brown Quick G1/4
31 SP2 solenoid (high pressure) ~ C/V (SP1 high pressure) Hydraulic hose (1/4) 490(19.3) Pink G1/4 Quick
32 SP2 solenoid (low pressure) ~ C/V (SP1 low pressure) Hydraulic hose (1/4) 830(32.7) Brown G1/4 G1/4
(a)
(e)
(c)
(d)
(f)
Hydraulic system
1 (P4, T) Collective block ~ P/V (left) (P) Hydraulic hose (1/4P, L-PV) 1390(54.7) White Quick Quick
2 (P4, T) Collective block ~ Dozer P/V (P) Hydraulic hose (1/4P, dozer PV) 1190(46.9) White Quick Quick
3 Dozer P/V (P) ~ P/V (right) (P) Hydraulic hose (1/4P, R-PV) 470(18.5) White Quick Quick
4 (P4, T) Collective block Travel P/V (P) Hydraulic hose (1/4P, travel PV) 210(8.3) White Quick G1/4
5 Travel P/V (P) ~ Swing P/V (P) Hydraulic hose (1/4P, swing PV) 190(7.5) White G1/4 Quick
6 P/V (swivel left) ~ Shuttle valve Hydraulic hose (1/4, swivel L1) 1660(65.4) Gray Quick Quick
7 P/V (swivel right) ~ Shuttle valve Hydraulic hose (1/4, swivel R1) 1660(65.4) Sky-blue Quick Quick
8 P/V (arm crowded) ~ Relay adaptor Hydraulic hose (1/4, arm C1) 1080(42.5) Blue Quick Quick
9 Relay adaptor ~ Shuttle valve (arm crowded) Hydraulic hose (1/4, arm C2) 490(19.3) Blue Quick Quick
10 P/V (arm dump) ~ Relay adaptor Hydraulic hose (1/4, arm D1) 1070(42.1) Yellowish green Quick Quick
11 Relay adaptor ~ Relay plate (arm dump) Hydraulic hose (1/4, arm D2) 530(20.9) Yellowish green Quick Quick
12 P/V (bucket crowded) ~ Relay plate Hydraulic hose (1/4, bucket C1) 1590(62.6) Orange Quick Quick
13 P/V (bucket dump) ~ Relay plate Hydraulic hose (1/4, bucket D1) 1610(63.4) Red Quick Quick
IV-S-231
14 P/V (boom up) ~ Relay adaptor Hydraulic hose (1/4, boom U1) 1690(66.5) Green Quick Quick
15 Relay adaptor ~ Relay plate (boom up) Hydraulic hose (1/4, boom U2) 530(20.9) Green Quick Quick
16 P/V (boom down) ~ Relay adaptor Hydraulic hose (1/4, boom D1) 1770(69.7) Yellow Quick Quick
17 Relay adaptor ~ Relay plate (boom down) Hydraulic hose (1/4, boom U2) 470(18.5) Yellow Quick Quick
18 Dozer P/V (up) ~ Relay plate Hydraulic hose (1/4, dozer U1) 1130(44.5) Pink Quick Quick
19 Dozer P/V (down) ~ Relay plate Hydraulic hose (1/4, dozer D2) 1185(46.7) Brown Quick Quick
Hydraulic system
14 Boom back (pipe) (arm dump) — Arm cylinder (rod) Hydraulic hose (1/2) 1955(77.0) Yellowish green Yokohama-made
15 C/V (travel right forward) — R/J (E) Hydraulic hose (5/8) 920(36.2) Yellow double Yokohama-made
16 C/V (travel right backward) — R/J (G) Hydraulic hose (5/8) 1025(40.4) Green double Yokohama-made
17 C/V (travel left forward) — R/J (D) Hydraulic hose (5/8) 950(37.4) Red double Yokohama-made
18 C/V (travel left backward) — R/J (F) Hydraulic hose (5/8) 1065(41.9) Yellowish green double Yokohama-made
19 C/V (swivel left) — Swivel motor (left) Hydraulic hose (1/2) 810(31.9) Gray Yokohama-made
20 C/V (swivel right) — Swivel motor (right) Hydraulic hose (1/2) 670(26.4) Sky-blue Yokohama-made
21 C/V (left) — Swing cylinder (bottom) Hydraulic hose (3/8) 1950(76.8) Yellowish green
22 C/V (right) — Swing cylinder (rod) Hydraulic hose (3/8) 2020(79.5) Orange
23 C/V (dozer down) — R/J (B) Hydraulic hose (1/2) 1175(46.3) Brown Yokohama-made
24 C/V (dozer up) — R/J (C) Hydraulic hose (1/2) 2020(79.5) Pink Yokohama-made
25 Boom back (pipe) — Bucket cylinder Hydraulic hose (5/8) 960(37.8) Spring wound overall
Hydraulic system
Hydraulic system
IV-S-234
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism V Electrical System
. Electrical system
Mechanism Section
V-M-1
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism V Electrical System
V-M-2
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism V Electrical System
V-M-3
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism V Electrical System
V-M-4
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism V Electrical System
Hand-control system
The hydraulic control grip has a small angle sensor built in. Signals from this sensor activate the propor-
tional solenoid valve to control the flow rate at the hydraulic service port stepless.
(1)
(2) Hand-control system
(6)
(5)
(4)
(3)
(1) Extend
(2) Control button
(2) (3) Retract
(1) (3)
V-M-5
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism V Electrical System
V-M-6
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism V Electrical System
NOTE:
z When turning the starter key to the RUN posi-
tion, the action mode will return to the last action
mode used.
V-M-7
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism V Electrical System
V-M-8
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism V Electrical System
V-M-9
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism V Electrical System
V-M-10
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism V Electrical System
Second service
First service port
port
Max. Flow
Volume
100 67
Theoretical
L/min.
Max. Pressure 20.6 20.6
MPa (kgf/cm2) (210) (210)
V-M-11
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism V Electrical System
Depicted contents
(1) Second service port switch
(2) First service port switch
(3) Horn switch
(4) One way hold lock switch
(5) Two travel speed switch
(6) Beacon light switch
(7) Starter switch
(8) Two speed indicator light
(9) Flow volume setting switch
V-M-12
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism V Electrical System
Voltage
5
Starting point current
2.5
Calculated virtual
0 Control knob angle
current
1.6 0 1.6 20 Neutral 20
Left SOL Right SOL Left SOL Right SOL
5. Pilot secondary pressure vs Main spool opening 6. Main spool opening vs service port flow input
Main spool
opening
Q
9. 8, 7
6
5
Ps 4
3
2
1
0 Ps
Limited output current Main spool opening
V-M-13
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism V Electrical System
(2)
(3)
(5)
V-M-14
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism V Electrical System
2. How to use
E
To avoid serious injury or death:
z Do not use the fuel supply pump for gasoline or
hydraulic oil. Doing so could result in explosion
or damage. Only use the fuel supply pump for
diesel fuel.
I
To avoid personal injury:
z When the fuel supply pump is used, be sure to
(1) Fuel tank cap open the fuel tank cap.
V-M-15
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism V Electrical System
V-M-16
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism V Electrical System
(7)
(8)
(9)
V-M-17
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism V Electrical System
(11) (10)
(6)
(7)
(8)
(9)
Function chart
Main key SW ON
OFF
V-M-18
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism V Electrical System
(7)
(8)
(9)
Function chart
Main key SW ON
OFF
V-M-19
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism V Electrical System
(3)
(5)
(1)
(11) (10)
(6)
(7)
(8)
(9)
Function chart
Main key SW ON
OFF
V-M-20
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism V Electrical System
V-M-21
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism V lectrical System
V-M-22
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism V Electrical System
16
Water temp °C Glow time s
14
-40 15 12
-20 15 10
0 3 (1) 8
40 3 6
4
41 0
2
140 0
0
-40 -20 0 20 40 60 80 100 120 140
(2)
35
Water temp °C Glow time s
30
-40 30
25
40 30
20
41 0 (1)
15
140 0
10
5
0
-40 -20 0 20 40 60 80 100 120 140
(2)
25
Key - off time s Max. Glow time s
20
0 0
5 3 15
15 8 (1) 10
30 12 5
45 15
0
90 21 0 20 40 60 80 100 120
120 25 (2)
V-M-23
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism V Electrical System
(1)
(1) Max. limit temperature
(2) Heater temperature
(3) Time
(2)
(3)
V-M-24
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism V Electrical System
2) Drawing
(1) Terminal
(2) Housing
Front (3) Label : Gray
Rear
(3)
Up
Down
(1)
(2)
Left Right
3) Diagram
(1) Connecter
(1)
V-M-25
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism V Electrical System
V-M-26
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism V Electrical System
(53)
(52)
(51)
(49)
(50)
(14)
(15)
(16)
(17)
(48) (18)
(47) (19)
(20)
(46)
(21)
(23)
(22)
(45) (27)
(28)
(29)
(30)
(31) (32)
(44)
(24)
(25)
(26)
(43) (42) (41) (40) (39) (38) (37) (36) (35) (34) (33)
V-M-27
V-M-28
V-M-29
V-M-30
V-M-31
V-M-32
V. Electrical system
Service Section
A.Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V-S-3
a.General guideline ........................................................................................... V-S-3
b.Troubleshooting flow chart .............................................................................. V-S-4
B.Wire harness installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V-S-7
a.Precautions ..................................................................................................... V-S-7
b.Engine earth, starter switch ............................................................................ V-S-8
c.Checking cables, wires and battery ............................................................... V-S-9
d.Wire harness route ....................................................................................... V-S-10
C.Installation of main parts, couplers and harnesses . V-S-16
a.Around the operation's seat ......................................................................... V-S-16
b.Front ............................................................................................................. V-S-18
c.Fuel tank ....................................................................................................... V-S-20
d.Starter, alternator, battery ............................................................................ V-S-22
e.Fuses ............................................................................................................ V-S-23
f. Solenoid valve wiring .................................................................................... V-S-24
g. Air conditioner wiring .................................................................................... V-S-25
h. Cab wire harness ......................................................................................... V-S-26
i. Circuit diagram of cab harness ..................................................................... V-S-29
V-S-1
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Electrical system
V-S-2
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Electrical system
A.Troubleshooting
a. General guideline
(1) How to diagnose
The most important point in troubleshooting is to determine "Probable Causes". Once the probable
causes are determined, parts to be checked can be limited to those associated with such probable
causes. Therefore, unnecessary checks can be eliminated. The determination of the probable causes
must be based on a theory and be supported by facts and must not be based on intuition only.
TROUBLESHOOTING STEPS
If an attempt is made to solve a problem without going through correct steps for troubleshooting, the
problem symptoms could become more complicated, resulting in failure to determine the causes cor-
rectly and making incorrect repairs.The four steps below should be followed in troubleshooting.
Observation of Problem
1 Symptoms Observe the symptom carefully. Check if there are also
other problems.
Repair and Confirmation After the problems are corrected, be sure to check that the
4 system operates correctly. Also check that new problems
have not been caused by the repair.
V-S-3
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Electrical system
Are both the right and left No Turn off both the lever lock switches.
lever lock switches on? (Are (Lift both the safety levers.)
both the safety levers up?)
Yes
Battery defective.
No
Does the starter relay and No Check starter relay or self-hold relay.
self-hold relay OK?
V-S-4
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Electrical system
The auto release function fails. The 1. Turning sensor out of contact or broken.
starter motor may wrongly get acti- 2. Relay.
vated.
Yes
Yes
V-S-5
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Electrical system
V-S-6
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Electrical system
Taping Harness
Clamp
1) The harness tapings indicate the clamping positions. Clamp at these specified points.
2) Clamp the harness tight enough not to come off nor get loose.
3) Insert the handgrip-equipped harness deep into their mating holes.
* Do not allow the harness to come out of the corrugated slit.
* Catch the cord clamp at the corrugated winding.
V-S-7
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Electrical system
S (1) Tightening torque of the cable fixing nut to the sel-motor (1)
terminal
Tightening torque 5.9 ~ 11.8 N·m (0.6 ~ 1.2 kgf·m) 4.34~8.68ft.lbs
S (2) Installation of starter switch (RC411-5346U)
1. Starter switch groove to be fitted to the projection of the
cover (top right)
2. Nut tightening torque 4.0 ~ 5.0 N·m (0.4 ~ 0.51 kgf·m) 2.89~3.69ft.lbs (A)
S (3) Checking the automatic starter release function
Start the engine, place the key switch back to the start position (2)
and make sure the starter is not activated.
(B)
(1)Projection (behind)
(2)Groove
(3)Cord (body ground)
(4)Bolt
(5)Bolt
V-S-8
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Electrical system
Caution
1. Before connecting or disconnecting the negative
cable, be sure to turn off the ignition switch and the
lighting switch.
(If this is not done, there is the possibility of semicon-
ductor parts being damaged.)
V-S-9
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Electrical system
d.Wireharness route
(1)
(2)
V-S-10
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Electrical system
(3)
(2)
(1)
(1)Battery
(2)Main wire harness
(3)To fuel tank
V-S-11
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Electrical system
(1)
(2)
(3)
V-S-12
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Electrical system
(1)
(5)
(4)
118
(2)
(3)
V-S-13
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Electrical system
V-S-14
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Electrical system
(1)
(2)
V-S-15
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Electrical system
1) 2)
3)
2) 3) 4) 5) 6) 7) 8)
12)
13)
V-S-16
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Electrical system
3)
4) 2)
1)
6)
7)Coupler, hbeacomSW
8)Coupler, travel high lamp
8) 7) 6)
15)
14)
13)
16)Coupler,
17)Engine stop solenoid
16)
17)
V-S-17
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Electrical system
b.Front
1)Horn
2)Coupler, work lamp
3)Coupler, boom overload SW
3) 1)
2)
4)
6)
7)Fuse box
8)Amp. unit
7)
8)
V-S-18
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Electrical system
V-S-19
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Electrical system
1) 2) c.Fuel tank
1)Fuel sensor
2)Lead SW, fuel amount
3)
4)ON SW
4) 5)OFF SW
5)
V-S-20
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Electrical system
1)Switch ON
2)Switch OFF
7) 6) 5) 3)4min. controller
4)Fuse A
5)Stop relay (NC, blue)
6)Stop relay (NO, NC)
7)Fuse A
4) 3) 1)
2)
8)Fuse box
9) 9)Fuse
8) 10)Coupler
11)
12)
10)
12) 11)
14)
13)
V-S-21
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Electrical system
3)
6)Alternator
6)
7)Fuse box
ޓ
7)
8) 9)
V-S-22
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Electrical system
e.Fuses
1.Fuse capacities and Circuits
(A) 5A Room Light
(H) 5A Glow
(D)
V-S-23
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Electrical system
(1)
(3)
(2)
(2)Service port 1 proportional solenoid valve
(3)Service port 2 solenoid valve
V-S-24
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Electrical system
1)
2)
3)
4)
V-S-25
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Electrical system
3)
4)
5)
5)Wiper motor
5)
V-S-26
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Electrical system
1)
3)
4)
5)
V-S-27
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Electrical system
1) 2) 3)
1)Inside the cap
2)Between the walls
3)Outside
V-S-28
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Electrical system
2)
1)
V-S-29
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service Electrical system
V-S-30
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism VI Air Conditioner
Mechanism Section
VI-M-1
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism VI Air Conditioner
VI-M-2
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism VI Air Conditioner
Heat-transferring substance
(Called a refrigerant)
Cab temperature decreases as the heat
amount emitted outside the cab.
VI-M-3
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism VI Air Conditioner
The principle of the air conditioner is as follows. By means of the expansion valve, the refrigerant in liquid form is rapidly
expanded and turned into low-temperature gas. This low-temperature gas is passed through the evaporator, which is so
designed that heat in the cabin can be absorbed effectively, and the cabin is cooled. Then the refrigerant in gaseous form,
which has absorbed heat in the cabin and increased its temperature a little, is compressed by the compressor and becomes
high-pressure and high-temperature gas. By means of the condenser, this high-pressure and high-temperature gas is air-
cooled and turned back into liquid. At this time, the refrigerant emits into the atmosphere the heat absorbed from the cabin.
This circulating system is called Refrigerant Cycle .
The following p-H diagram describes each state of refrigerant. 1: Dry vapor
1o2: Adiabatic compression by means of com-
Liquid pressor
2: Superheated vapor
Condenser Dry saturated vapor 2o2 o3: Isobaric change by means of condenser
Heating (condensation through heat emission)
3: Saturated liquid
3o4: Isoentropic change by means of expansion
Heat emission valve (restriction phenomenon)
Saturated Gas 4: Wet vapor
Pressure P
VI-M-4
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism VI Air Conditioner
(3) Function and construction ote : alues of temperature an pressure in belo Fig.
are not specifications but ust sample ata.
Air conditioner body assembly Cold air supply opening Evaporator
In general it is a component part to blow cold air into The atomized refrigerant evaporates to turn
the cabin. into gas while drawing heat from the surround-
ings through the cooling fin.
Evaporation
Blower motor
It is used to pressurize and send cabin air to the
evaporator and to send cooled air to the cabin.
Temperature sensor tube
It is used to sense the temperature at the outlet Expansion
of the evaporator and automatically adjust the Expansion valve
opening of the expansion valve. It is used to expand the refrigerant rapidly to turn it into
low-pressure and low-temperature liquid (atomized liquid).
Temperature: 8°C
Low-pressure and low-temperature gas Gas filling to 15°C
Low-pressure and low- Temperature: Pressure: 1.0 to 2
temperature liquid 50°C to 60°C kg/cm2
Liquid
Gauge pressure
VI-M-5
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism VI Air Conditioner
VI-M-6
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism VI Air Conditioner
2) Compression
The compressor compresses the refrigerant to a state in which the refrigerant can be easily liquefied at
ordinary temperature (outside air temperature).
The gas generated through evaporation in the evaporator (superheated vapor) is sucked into the com-
pressor. This operation is intended to keep the evaporating pressure in the evaporator at a low level so
that the refrigerant in liquid form can evaporate even at low temperatures around 0°C. The gas (super-
heated vapor) sucked into the compressor is compressed in the vane chamber and becomes such high-
pressure and high-temperature gas as can be easily liquefied by being cooled with outside air at ordinary
temperature.
3) Condensation
The refrigerant is cooled with outside air in the condenser and changes from gas to liquid.
The high-pressure and high-temperature gas coming out of the compressor is cooled with outside air, liq-
uefied and stored in the receiver. The heat emitted from the high-pressure and high-temperature gas
coming out of the compressor is called heat of condensation.
This heat of condensation is equal to the sum of the heat drawn from the cabin (evaporation heat) by the
refrigerant in the evaporator and the energy used for compression (converted to heat quantity).
In the case of condensation, like the case of evaporation, there is a certain relation between the pressure
(condensing pressure) and temperature (condensing temperature) during a state of change from gas to
liquid performed with vapor and liquid coexisting. (Note that the pressure varies depending on the type
of refrigerant and the condensing temperature.)
4) Expansion
The expansion valve reduces the pressure of the refrigerant in liquid form to a state in which the refriger-
ant can be easily evaporated.
Before the liquefied refrigerant is sent to the evaporator, its pressure is reduced to a state in which it can
be easily evaporated, which is called an expansion process. The expansion valve used for this process
performs flow control of the refrigerant as well as pressure reduction.
The amount of refrigerant to be evaporated in the evaporator is determined by the heat quantity to be
removed (cooling load) at a given evaporating temperature (evaporating pressure). It is important to
catch it correctly and feed a proper amount of refrigerant.
The refrigerant circulates through the cooling system while going through the above-mentioned four pro-
cesses. As a result, it transfers heat from the cabin to the outside air, that is, from low temperatures to
high temperatures.
VI-M-7
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism VI Air Conditioner
VI-M-8
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism VI Air Conditioner
b. Control panel
Mounted on actual machine
(1) Fan switch: Used to turn on and off the fan and to select the airflow in 3 steps.
(2) Air conditioner switch: Used to turn on the compressor to start cooling.
(3) Temperature adjusting lever: Used to adjust the blow temperature by opening and closing the hot-
water valve via cable.
For KX080-3
VI-M-9
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism VI Air Conditioner
C.Main components
a. Compressor
The compressor is installed on the engine and is driven by crank pulley through a belt.
The compressor is a pump designed to raise the pressure of refrigerant. Raising the pressure means
raising the temperature. High temperature refrigerant vapor will condense rapidly in the condenser by
releasing heat to the surrounding.
Suction port
Discharge
valve
Discharge port Discharge
port
Suction port
Discharge valve
Cylinder Vane
(2) Feature
1) The rotor, cylinder and other major parts are made of aluminum for tremendous drop in weight.
2) The vanes are used to make the compressor compact.
3) Compared to conventional swash-plate compressors, the SV07 is compact with smaller cylinder
capacity. Thanks to the better volumetric efficiency, however, the SV07 proves as powerful as the
10P08.
VI-M-10
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism VI Air Conditioner
1 Construction
2) Shaft
The shaft is integrated with the rotor. The front of the shaft is supported by the needle bearing which
is fitted in the front side plate. The rear is supported by plain bearing which is fitted in the rear side
bearing.
The end of the shaft is provided with splines, and the magnetic clutch (K type) that mates to the
spline shaft is secured by a bolt (M6), in the same way as in the through-vane type compressor.
3) ear Si e late
The rear side plate is equipped with a valve that prevents the vanes from chattering during starting.
VI-M-11
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism VI Air Conditioner
2 Operation
1) Suction
The refrigerant gas exits from the evaporator by the operation of the compressor, enters the com-
pressor s low-pressure chamber. As the rotor turns together with the vanes, the refrigerant gas is
drawn from the suction port into the cylinder.
2) ompression
After completing suction, the refrigerant gas, which is sealed by the vanes in the cylinder, becomes
compressed as the vanes rotate. At this time, the sealing between the tip of the vanes and the cylin-
der wall is ensured by the compressor oil.
3) ischarge
At the compression continues and the refrigerant pressure in the cylinder increases to the point that
it becomes higher than that of the high-pressure chamber, the refrigerant gas is discharged.
Even when the pressure in cylinder because the high-pressure chamber pressure maintains the dis-
charge valve closed.
The compressor repeats the cycle described above to enable the five chambers, which are parti-
tioned by the vanes in the cylinder, to perform suction, compression, and discharge twice for each
rotation of the rotor.
VI-M-12
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism VI Air Conditioner
(2) Body
(3) Seal
(3) (4) (5) (6) (4) Poppet
(2)
(5) Spring
(6) Stopper
VI-M-13
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism VI Air Conditioner
c. Magnetic clutch
A magnetic clutch is used to connect and
disconnect the compressor from the engine.
The main components are the stator, rotor,
and pressure plate.
(1) Principle
When the current is supplied to the coil,
magnetic forces are generated in the iron II
and attracts the iron I.
(3) Operation
Whenever the engine is operating, the pulley
is rotating since it is connected to the crank-
shaft by a drive belt, but the compressor
does not operate until the magnetic clutch is
energized. When the air conditioning system
is switched on, the system supplies current
to the stator coil. Then the electromagnetic
field attracts the pressure plate and pulls the
plate against the friction facings on the pul-
ley. The friction between the facings on the
pulley and pressure plate causes the mag-
netic clutch assembly to rotate as a unit, and
drive the compressor.
Fig. Operation
VI-M-14
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism VI Air Conditioner
d. Condenser
(1) Description
The condenser is used to cool down the high
temperature and high pressure gas refriger-
ant and change it to a liquid refrigerant.
The greater the amount of the heat released
off into the air through the condenser, the
greater will be the cooling effect obtained by
the evaporator.
Therefore, the condenser is installed at the
front end of the vehicle to get forcible cooling
by the machine when moving.
There are some models which are equipped
with a fan exclusively for the condenser.
VI-M-15
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism VI Air Conditioner
e. Receiver
The receiver (3) serves the purpose of
(2)
storing the liquid refrigerant. The amount
(1) of the liquid refrigerant flowing through the
system varies with the operating condition
of the air conditioner. To be accurate, the
receiver stores excess amount of refriger-
ant when the heat load is lowered. It also
releases stored refrigerant when addi-
tional cooling is needed, thus, maintaining
the optimum flow of refrigerant within the
(3)
system.
The receiver includes a desiccant (5). It
has the job of removing moisture as the
refrigerant circulates within the system.
The sight glass (2) is installed on the top
of receiver. Amount of refrigerant to be
charged is very important for the effi-
ciency of air conditioner. The sight glass is
used to check the amount of refrigerant. If
large flow of bubbles can be seen in the
sight glass, there is insufficient refrigerant
charged. If so, replenish the refrigerant to
the proper level.
(1) Condenser
(2) Sight Glass
(3) Receiver
(4) Receiver Body
(5) Desiccant (silicagel ozeolite)
a : IN
b : OUT
VI-M-16
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism VI Air Conditioner
(1)
VI-M-17
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism VI Air Conditioner
VI-M-18
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism VI Air Conditioner
i. Evaporator
The purpose of evaporator (2) is just opposite to
that of the condenser. The state of refrigerant
immediately after the expansion valve (4) is
100% liquid. As soon as the liquid pressure
drops, it starts to boil, and in doing so, absorbs
heat. This heat is removed from the air passing (4)
over the cooling fins of the evaporator and
causes the air to cool.
If too much refrigerant is sent into the evaporator,
it will not boil away so easily. Also, the evaporator
filled with liquid refrigerant eliminates a place for (2)
the refrigerant to properly vaporize, which is nec-
essary in order to take on heat. A flooding condi-
tion of the evaporator will allow an excess of
liquid refrigerant to leave the evaporator and may
cause serious damage to the compressor.
If too little refrigerant is sent into the evaporator,
again the evaporator will not cool because the
refrigerant will vaporize, or boil off, long before it
passes through the evaporator.
Refrigerant properly metered into the evapora-
tor should allow for 100% liquid just after the
expansion valve, and 100% gas at the outlet.
j. Heater core
The heater-source of heater utilizes coolant which
becomes high temperature by heat of engine.
The inlet port heater core is connected to the
delivery side of engine water pump by a rubber
hose, and the water valve is installed on the inlet
port of heater core.
Also, the outlet port of heater core is connected to
the engine cylinder block.
The heater core (1) is one of the heat exchangers
like evaporator or condenser, and heat is
(1) exchanged between heated coolant passing
through the core and air in the cabin or fresh out-
door air. Thus, air is heated.
VI-M-19
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism VI Air Conditioner
k. Water valve
The hot water valve (1) is connected with
the got water valve cable (2) and con-
trolled with the temperature control lever
on the control panel. This lever is used to
(2)
adjust the flow rate of hot water going into
the heater.
Set the temperature control lever to the
COOL position and the hot water valve
gets closed, allowing no hot water flow.
The hot water valve is built in at the right-
hand top of the center pillar.
(1)
(1) Hot Water Valve
(2) Hot Water Valve Cable
Heater core
inlet
Engine side
VI-M-20
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism VI Air Conditioner
l. A/C blower
The blower is incorporated in the right-
hand space of the air conditioner unit. It
blows cool, warm of fresh air via the front
and side blow ports into the cabin.
The speed of the blower motor (1) can be
adjusted in 3 steps by the resistor (2).
The blower fan (3) is centrifugal type. The
air being sucked in parallel with the rotary
shaft is blown in the centrifugal direction;
in other words, perpendicular to the rotary
shaft.
(1)
VI-M-21
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism VI Air Conditioner
2 Structure
2
1
3
3 Current flow
1 2 3 1 2
Low position Medium position
4 Testing
1 3
VI-M-22
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism VI Air Conditioner
n. Relays
(1) (2)
VI-M-23
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism VI Air Conditioner
D.Frost control
Function
The evaporator fin temperature is sensed. If detected too low, the compressor is interrupted to prevent
the evaporator from freezing.
a. KX121-3, 161-3
Thermostat
Faston terminal 250
Function
The evaporator fin temperature is sensed by a refrigerant-filled capillary tube. If the temperature drops
below a specified level, the pressure in the internal bellows drops too. The contact is now broken to turn
off the compressor clutch power.
(7)
(8) (9)
(7) Contact
(8) Bellows
(9) Capillary tube
VI-M-24
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism VI Air Conditioner
b. KX080-3
Sensor
Thermo amplifier
Fin thermistor
Connector
0901F, 5P or equivalent
PBT-N-1 (black)
Mating connector
Yazaki part code 7283-1050
Specifications
Rated voltage DC12V
Measuring conditions DC13 0.2 V at 25 5°C
OFF R1 4383 131 : (2°C)
Temperature detection (RTH) ON R2 (4095 :) (3.35°C)
(Note 4)
Hysteresis 215 +145 0: (1°C)
Operating conditions
Operating temperature range -30 80°C
Operating voltage range DC10 16V
Activating voltage range DC8 1GV (at 25°C)
Function
The evaporator fin temperature is sensed by the sensor of fin thermistor. If the sensor s internal resis-
tance rises above the thermo amplifier s set resistance, the internal circuit is activated to turn off the
compressor clutch power.
VI-M-25
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism VI Air Conditioner
Thermostat
VI-M-26
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism VI Air Conditioner
b. KX080-3
4 6
3 ACr THr
5 7
VI-M-27
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Mechanism VI ir Conditioner
VI-M-28
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service VI Air Conditioner
VI-S-1
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service VI Air Conditioner
VI-S-2
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service VI Air Conditioner
A.Servicing specifications
a. Specifications of A/C system and components
Power consumption 150 W 10% Vehicle duct resistance: 310 Pa (including air supply
grille)
Capacity 3.6 kW 10% Difference between air and water temperatures: 65 C
Hot water flow: 6 L/min
Heater
Air flow 3
250 m /h 10%
Terminal voltage of blower motor: 13.5 V
Vehicle duct resistance: 460 Pa (including air supply
Power consumption 140 W 10%
grille)
Model SV07E
Compressor
Pulley efficacy dia. 108 Nut tightening torque = 19.6 Nxm (200 kgfxcm)
Power consumption 35 W or less
Weight 2.82kg
Height 264.2
Specifications
Thickness 16.1
of core
Height 165
Specifications of
Thickness 58
Fin type
Corrugated fin, 4 mm
Pitch
Height 140
Cooler unit
Specifications of
Thickness 21
Fin type
Corrugated fin, 1.8 mm
Pitch
Moisture absorption
32 g 60 C, 90% in air (Desiccant: 290 g)
capacity
VI-S-3
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service VI Air Conditioner
VI-S-4
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service VI Air Conditioner
b. Performance specifications
VI-S-5
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service VI Air Conditioner
VI-S-6
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service VI Air Conditioner
e. Tightening torques
Tightening torques of screws, bolts and nuts on the table below are especially specified.
(For general use screws, bolts, and nuts : See page G-11.)
Reference: Lub.oil
Replacing Parts Approx Replenish Quantity Brand Name
20 cc
Condenser 0.021 U.S.qts.
0.018 Imp.qts.
20 cc
ND-OIL 8
Evaporator 0.021 U.S.qts.
PAG oil
0.018 Imp.qts.
10 cc
Receiver 0.011 U.S.qts.
0.009 Imp.qts.
VI-S-7
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service VI Air Conditioner
Important
2 Clean and replace the air filter more frequently if used under dusty conditions. By heavy soiling,
replace the filter.
VI-S-8
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service VI Air Conditioner
C.Troubleshooting
a. Procedure
The chart shows the basic troubleshooting procedure.
Car air conditioner troubles are roughly classified in the refrigeration cycle and electrical system. In this
chapter the basic troubleshooting procedure is discussed.
epairing an ouble-chec ing Call the user at a later date about the machine condition.
What to ask
What Type of machine, model of engine, model of air conditioner
When Date, time, how often
Where Worksite (road) condition
Why Running condition, weather
How Feeling of phenomenon
VI-S-9
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service VI Air Conditioner
Sensor circuit
Refer
Wire harness
Body ground
Connectors
No. Problem to
Others page
Fuses
1
1 Fuse is blown out easily { { { {
Blower motor, Blower resistor, Blower
2 No blower operation { { { { switch
Blower resistor
3 Blower speed does not change { { { { Blower switch
Magnetic clutch relay Compressor
5 No compressor operation { { { { A/C switch
6 A/C lamp does not light { { { { A/C switch
A/C lamp flashes. Compressor, V-ribbed belt
7
(only for compressor with lock sensor)
{ { { { Magnetic clutch
8 No A/C operation (No cool air comes out) { { { {
Room temp. does not decrease (insuffi-
9
cient cooling)
{ { { { {
Engine coolant volume,
10 No warm air comes out
A/C temp. control lever Heater radiator
ote : 1 : Sensors are thermistor, pressure switch and water temp. switch.
Compressor: Charge the same amount of oil as that of the old compressor.
Compressor oil:ND-8 for the scroll (SCS) and swash plate types
ND-OIL9 for the vane (SV) type
ote : An open oil container is easy to absorb moisture from the air. Close the lid immediately after use.
VI-S-10
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service VI Air Conditioner
ouble-chec ing
erformance test
1: If the outside air temperature is higher than 40°C, the high-pressure side level may be above 1.86
MPa (19 kgf/cm2) in the above conditions. In such case, (1) fully close the door and set the blower
speed to LO, and/or (2) park the machine in a workshop or in the shade, in order to get the level
lower than 1.86 MPa (19 kgf/cm2).
VI-S-11
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service VI Air Conditioner
Reference
On the EPR (Evaporator Pressure Regulator) type car air conditioner, the low-pressure side level rises
and drops from the level of about 0.18 MPa (1.8 kgf/cm2) at regular intervals, if the outside air temper-
ature is low.
The gauge manifold may read somewhat different pressures depending on the conditions.
An overcharge of refrigerant may cause poor cooling effect, overheat or other trouble.
(1) (2)
2) Look at the sight glass to see how well the refrigerant flows in the air conditioner circuit.
For all the systems other than subcool condenser type
Refrigerant charge Condition
Proper amount No or little bubbles are contained. Gradually raise the engine speed from idling to 1500 rpm,
and the bubbles disappear and the fluid becomes transparent.
Overcharge No bubbles are contained. The pressures at both the high-pressure and low-pressure sides are
too high, resulting in poor cooling effect.
Refrigerant shortage Bubbles appear continuously.
VI-S-12
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service VI Air Conditioner
Reference
On a machine equipped with variable displacement compressor or EPR, the suction pressure is con-
trolled. Even if the low-pressure side level is not as specified, the gauge may fail to show such error. In
such case, consider the high-pressure side level, blow-out temperature, sight-glass bubbles and other
factors to make an overall judgment.
The gauge manifold may read somewhat different pressures depending on the conditions.
1) Normal condition
Low-pressure side level 0.15 0.25 MPa (1.5 2.5 kgf/cm2)
(1) (2)
VI-S-13
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service VI Air Conditioner
2) Refrigerant shortage
Phenomenon Possible cause Correction
Too low pressure at both low-pressure Refrigerant too short. Gas leak. Pinpoint and repair the leaky spot.
and high-pressure sides Add refrigerant.
Bubbles flowing continuously in the
sight glass
Poor cooling effect
(1) (2)
(1) (2)
VI-S-14
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service VI Air Conditioner
(1) (2)
(1) (2)
VI-S-15
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service VI Air Conditioner
(1) (2)
(1) (2)
VI-S-16
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service VI Air Conditioner
(1) (2)
Read the gauge pressure with the compressor at rest. The outside air temperature must be above
15°C, however.
When the gauge pressure is above 0.4 MPa (4 kgf/cm2) or so, go straight to check.
If the gauge pressure is below 0.4 MPa (4 kgf/cm2), add refrigerant to achieve the 0.4 MPa (4 kgf/cm2)
level and then go to check.
Reference
Check for gas leak in a well-ventilated place. If the sensor of an electric gas leak detector gets exposed
to gasoline, light oil or auto emission, it may wrongly react to these gases.
Gas leaking from a pipe connection may get blown away even by breeze. Apply the tip of the probe all
around the connection, not on a single spot.
(1)
(1) Probe
VI-S-17
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service VI Air Conditioner
No leak
Yes
Is fluorescent dye added Check with a fluorescent gas leak detector
with the machine 1? (inspection lamp).
No
isual chec
Visually check the pipe connections, Add fluorescent dye 3 .
among others, for oozing oil.
Leaky
No leak
echec ing
Check with an electric gas leak detector. No leak Fill up with a specified amount of refrigerant.
Turn on the air conditioner 2 and check again.
Leaky
1: Machines with fluorescent dye added are identified with a label or the like.
2: When the air conditioner runs, the engine gets vibrated and the refrigeration cycle gets under pressure for easily
detecting a leak.
3: Fluorescent dye is added under the pressure of a gas container. Be careful not to apply it too much.
VI-S-18
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service VI Air Conditioner
No
ea e intact.
Blower speed: OFF
Leave-intact time: About 10 minutes
Inside/outside air select mode: Inside air mode
echec ing
Turn on and off the blower in a flash (0.5 second).
Then check each blow port again.
: Take this action, because fluorescent dye flows away with drain if the evaporator is leaky.
VI-S-19
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service VI Air Conditioner
(4) Precautions
Preparations
Gauge manifold kit Dry-bulb thermometer CFC gas recovery unit
Psychrometer Thickness gauge Circlip pliers
Circuit tester Platform scale
VI-S-20
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service VI Air Conditioner
VI-S-21
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
WSM KX080-3 Service VI Air Conditioner
VI-S-22
Downloaded from www.Manualslib.com manuals search engine
ss
Conversion Tables